summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/config
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorKarel Zak <kzak@redhat.com>2006-12-07 00:26:54 +0100
committerKarel Zak <kzak@redhat.com>2006-12-07 00:26:54 +0100
commit48d7b13a1eab85fab91c8d6c5ddf298f733c74f5 (patch)
tree8813d36590ee3361bd75f57a12fd2032e9296ddb /config
parent2ab8f9d3cec110ce8291f2525fe90239aeef8376 (diff)
downloadutil-linux-old-48d7b13a1eab85fab91c8d6c5ddf298f733c74f5.tar.gz
Imported from util-linux-2.13-pre1 tarball.
Diffstat (limited to 'config')
-rwxr-xr-xconfig/compile142
-rwxr-xr-xconfig/config.rpath571
-rwxr-xr-xconfig/depcomp530
-rw-r--r--config/include-Makefile.am12
-rwxr-xr-xconfig/install-sh323
-rw-r--r--config/ltmain.sh6426
-rwxr-xr-xconfig/missing360
-rwxr-xr-xconfig/mkinstalldirs158
-rw-r--r--config/texinfo.tex7210
9 files changed, 15732 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/config/compile b/config/compile
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..1b1d2321
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/compile
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# Wrapper for compilers which do not understand `-c -o'.
+
+scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
+
+# Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Written by Tom Tromey <tromey@cygnus.com>.
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
+
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
+# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
+# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+
+case $1 in
+ '')
+ echo "$0: No command. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ exit 1;
+ ;;
+ -h | --h*)
+ cat <<\EOF
+Usage: compile [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS]
+
+Wrapper for compilers which do not understand `-c -o'.
+Remove `-o dest.o' from ARGS, run PROGRAM with the remaining
+arguments, and rename the output as expected.
+
+If you are trying to build a whole package this is not the
+right script to run: please start by reading the file `INSTALL'.
+
+Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
+EOF
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ -v | --v*)
+ echo "compile $scriptversion"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+esac
+
+ofile=
+cfile=
+eat=
+
+for arg
+do
+ if test -n "$eat"; then
+ eat=
+ else
+ case $1 in
+ -o)
+ # configure might choose to run compile as `compile cc -o foo foo.c'.
+ # So we strip `-o arg' only if arg is an object.
+ eat=1
+ case $2 in
+ *.o | *.obj)
+ ofile=$2
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set x "$@" -o "$2"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ *.c)
+ cfile=$1
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set x "$@" "$1"
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ shift
+done
+
+if test -z "$ofile" || test -z "$cfile"; then
+ # If no `-o' option was seen then we might have been invoked from a
+ # pattern rule where we don't need one. That is ok -- this is a
+ # normal compilation that the losing compiler can handle. If no
+ # `.c' file was seen then we are probably linking. That is also
+ # ok.
+ exec "$@"
+fi
+
+# Name of file we expect compiler to create.
+cofile=`echo "$cfile" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.c$/.o/'`
+
+# Create the lock directory.
+# Note: use `[/.-]' here to ensure that we don't use the same name
+# that we are using for the .o file. Also, base the name on the expected
+# object file name, since that is what matters with a parallel build.
+lockdir=`echo "$cofile" | sed -e 's|[/.-]|_|g'`.d
+while true; do
+ if mkdir "$lockdir" >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ break
+ fi
+ sleep 1
+done
+# FIXME: race condition here if user kills between mkdir and trap.
+trap "rmdir '$lockdir'; exit 1" 1 2 15
+
+# Run the compile.
+"$@"
+ret=$?
+
+if test -f "$cofile"; then
+ mv "$cofile" "$ofile"
+elif test -f "${cofile}bj"; then
+ mv "${cofile}bj" "$ofile"
+fi
+
+rmdir "$lockdir"
+exit $ret
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode: shell-script
+# sh-indentation: 2
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# End:
diff --git a/config/config.rpath b/config/config.rpath
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..3f1bef34
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/config.rpath
@@ -0,0 +1,571 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# Output a system dependent set of variables, describing how to set the
+# run time search path of shared libraries in an executable.
+#
+# Copyright 1996-2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Taken from GNU libtool, 2001
+# Originally by Gordon Matzigkeit <gord@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996
+#
+# This file is free software; the Free Software Foundation gives
+# unlimited permission to copy and/or distribute it, with or without
+# modifications, as long as this notice is preserved.
+#
+# The first argument passed to this file is the canonical host specification,
+# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-OPERATING_SYSTEM
+# or
+# CPU_TYPE-MANUFACTURER-KERNEL-OPERATING_SYSTEM
+# The environment variables CC, GCC, LDFLAGS, LD, with_gnu_ld
+# should be set by the caller.
+#
+# The set of defined variables is at the end of this script.
+
+# Known limitations:
+# - On IRIX 6.5 with CC="cc", the run time search patch must not be longer
+# than 256 bytes, otherwise the compiler driver will dump core. The only
+# known workaround is to choose shorter directory names for the build
+# directory and/or the installation directory.
+
+# All known linkers require a `.a' archive for static linking (except M$VC,
+# which needs '.lib').
+libext=a
+shrext=.so
+
+host="$1"
+host_cpu=`echo "$host" | sed 's/^\([^-]*\)-\([^-]*\)-\(.*\)$/\1/'`
+host_vendor=`echo "$host" | sed 's/^\([^-]*\)-\([^-]*\)-\(.*\)$/\2/'`
+host_os=`echo "$host" | sed 's/^\([^-]*\)-\([^-]*\)-\(.*\)$/\3/'`
+
+cc_basename=`echo "$CC" | sed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+
+# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_PROG_COMPILER_PIC.
+
+wl=
+if test "$GCC" = yes; then
+ wl='-Wl,'
+else
+ case "$host_os" in
+ aix*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ darwin*)
+ case "$cc_basename" in
+ xlc*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ mingw* | pw32* | os2*)
+ ;;
+ hpux9* | hpux10* | hpux11*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ newsos6)
+ ;;
+ linux*)
+ case $cc_basename in
+ icc* | ecc*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ pgcc | pgf77 | pgf90)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ ccc*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ como)
+ wl='-lopt='
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ osf3* | osf4* | osf5*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ sco3.2v5*)
+ ;;
+ solaris*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ sunos4*)
+ wl='-Qoption ld '
+ ;;
+ sysv4 | sysv4.2uw2* | sysv4.3* | sysv5*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ sysv4*MP*)
+ ;;
+ unicos*)
+ wl='-Wl,'
+ ;;
+ uts4*)
+ ;;
+ esac
+fi
+
+# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_PROG_LD_SHLIBS.
+
+hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=
+hardcode_libdir_separator=
+hardcode_direct=no
+hardcode_minus_L=no
+
+case "$host_os" in
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ # FIXME: the MSVC++ port hasn't been tested in a loooong time
+ # When not using gcc, we currently assume that we are using
+ # Microsoft Visual C++.
+ if test "$GCC" != yes; then
+ with_gnu_ld=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ openbsd*)
+ with_gnu_ld=no
+ ;;
+esac
+
+ld_shlibs=yes
+if test "$with_gnu_ld" = yes; then
+ case "$host_os" in
+ aix3* | aix4* | aix5*)
+ # On AIX/PPC, the GNU linker is very broken
+ if test "$host_cpu" != ia64; then
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ amigaos*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ # Samuel A. Falvo II <kc5tja@dolphin.openprojects.net> reports
+ # that the semantics of dynamic libraries on AmigaOS, at least up
+ # to version 4, is to share data among multiple programs linked
+ # with the same dynamic library. Since this doesn't match the
+ # behavior of shared libraries on other platforms, we cannot use
+ # them.
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ ;;
+ beos*)
+ if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
+ :
+ else
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ # hardcode_libdir_flag_spec is actually meaningless, as there is
+ # no search path for DLLs.
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep 'auto-import' > /dev/null; then
+ :
+ else
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ netbsd*)
+ ;;
+ solaris* | sysv5*)
+ if $LD -v 2>&1 | grep 'BFD 2\.8' > /dev/null; then
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ elif $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
+ :
+ else
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ sunos4*)
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ ;;
+ linux*)
+ if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
+ :
+ else
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if $LD --help 2>&1 | grep ': supported targets:.* elf' > /dev/null; then
+ :
+ else
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if test "$ld_shlibs" = yes; then
+ # Unlike libtool, we use -rpath here, not --rpath, since the documented
+ # option of GNU ld is called -rpath, not --rpath.
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
+ fi
+else
+ case "$host_os" in
+ aix3*)
+ # Note: this linker hardcodes the directories in LIBPATH if there
+ # are no directories specified by -L.
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ if test "$GCC" = yes; then
+ # Neither direct hardcoding nor static linking is supported with a
+ # broken collect2.
+ hardcode_direct=unsupported
+ fi
+ ;;
+ aix4* | aix5*)
+ if test "$host_cpu" = ia64; then
+ # On IA64, the linker does run time linking by default, so we don't
+ # have to do anything special.
+ aix_use_runtimelinking=no
+ else
+ aix_use_runtimelinking=no
+ # Test if we are trying to use run time linking or normal
+ # AIX style linking. If -brtl is somewhere in LDFLAGS, we
+ # need to do runtime linking.
+ case $host_os in aix4.[23]|aix4.[23].*|aix5*)
+ for ld_flag in $LDFLAGS; do
+ if (test $ld_flag = "-brtl" || test $ld_flag = "-Wl,-brtl"); then
+ aix_use_runtimelinking=yes
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ esac
+ fi
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=':'
+ if test "$GCC" = yes; then
+ case $host_os in aix4.[012]|aix4.[012].*)
+ collect2name=`${CC} -print-prog-name=collect2`
+ if test -f "$collect2name" && \
+ strings "$collect2name" | grep resolve_lib_name >/dev/null
+ then
+ # We have reworked collect2
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ else
+ # We have old collect2
+ hardcode_direct=unsupported
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=
+ fi
+ esac
+ fi
+ # Begin _LT_AC_SYS_LIBPATH_AIX.
+ echo 'int main () { return 0; }' > conftest.c
+ ${CC} ${LDFLAGS} conftest.c -o conftest
+ aix_libpath=`dump -H conftest 2>/dev/null | sed -n -e '/Import File Strings/,/^$/ { /^0/ { s/^0 *\(.*\)$/\1/; p; }
+}'`
+ if test -z "$aix_libpath"; then
+ aix_libpath=`dump -HX64 conftest 2>/dev/null | sed -n -e '/Import File Strings/,/^$/ { /^0/ { s/^0 *\(.*\)$/\1/; p; }
+}'`
+ fi
+ if test -z "$aix_libpath"; then
+ aix_libpath="/usr/lib:/lib"
+ fi
+ rm -f conftest.c conftest
+ # End _LT_AC_SYS_LIBPATH_AIX.
+ if test "$aix_use_runtimelinking" = yes; then
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-blibpath:$libdir:'"$aix_libpath"
+ else
+ if test "$host_cpu" = ia64; then
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-R $libdir:/usr/lib:/lib'
+ else
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-blibpath:$libdir:'"$aix_libpath"
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+ amigaos*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ # see comment about different semantics on the GNU ld section
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ ;;
+ bsdi[45]*)
+ ;;
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ # When not using gcc, we currently assume that we are using
+ # Microsoft Visual C++.
+ # hardcode_libdir_flag_spec is actually meaningless, as there is
+ # no search path for DLLs.
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=' '
+ libext=lib
+ ;;
+ darwin* | rhapsody*)
+ hardcode_direct=no
+ if test "$GCC" = yes ; then
+ :
+ else
+ case "$cc_basename" in
+ xlc*)
+ ;;
+ *)
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ ;;
+ dgux*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ ;;
+ freebsd1*)
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ ;;
+ freebsd2.2*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ ;;
+ freebsd2*)
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ freebsd* | kfreebsd*-gnu | dragonfly*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ ;;
+ hpux9*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}+b ${wl}$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ # hardcode_minus_L: Not really in the search PATH,
+ # but as the default location of the library.
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ hpux10* | hpux11*)
+ if test "$with_gnu_ld" = no; then
+ case "$host_cpu" in
+ hppa*64*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}+b ${wl}$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ hardcode_direct=no
+ ;;
+ ia64*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_direct=no
+ # hardcode_minus_L: Not really in the search PATH,
+ # but as the default location of the library.
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ *)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}+b ${wl}$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ # hardcode_minus_L: Not really in the search PATH,
+ # but as the default location of the library.
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ ;;
+ irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ ;;
+ netbsd*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ ;;
+ newsos6)
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ ;;
+ openbsd*)
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ if test -z "`echo __ELF__ | $CC -E - | grep __ELF__`" || test "$host_os-$host_cpu" = "openbsd2.8-powerpc"; then
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
+ else
+ case "$host_os" in
+ openbsd[01].* | openbsd2.[0-7] | openbsd2.[0-7].*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
+ ;;
+ *)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath,$libdir'
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ ;;
+ os2*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ osf3*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ ;;
+ osf4* | osf5*)
+ if test "$GCC" = yes; then
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='${wl}-rpath ${wl}$libdir'
+ else
+ # Both cc and cxx compiler support -rpath directly
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-rpath $libdir'
+ fi
+ hardcode_libdir_separator=:
+ ;;
+ sco3.2v5*)
+ ;;
+ solaris*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-R$libdir'
+ ;;
+ sunos4*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ hardcode_minus_L=yes
+ ;;
+ sysv4)
+ case $host_vendor in
+ sni)
+ hardcode_direct=yes # is this really true???
+ ;;
+ siemens)
+ hardcode_direct=no
+ ;;
+ motorola)
+ hardcode_direct=no #Motorola manual says yes, but my tests say they lie
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ sysv4.3*)
+ ;;
+ sysv4*MP*)
+ if test -d /usr/nec; then
+ ld_shlibs=yes
+ fi
+ ;;
+ sysv4.2uw2*)
+ hardcode_direct=yes
+ hardcode_minus_L=no
+ ;;
+ sysv5OpenUNIX8* | sysv5UnixWare7* | sysv5uw[78]* | unixware7*)
+ ;;
+ sysv5*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=
+ ;;
+ uts4*)
+ hardcode_libdir_flag_spec='-L$libdir'
+ ;;
+ *)
+ ld_shlibs=no
+ ;;
+ esac
+fi
+
+# Check dynamic linker characteristics
+# Code taken from libtool.m4's AC_LIBTOOL_SYS_DYNAMIC_LINKER.
+libname_spec='lib$name'
+case "$host_os" in
+ aix3*)
+ ;;
+ aix4* | aix5*)
+ ;;
+ amigaos*)
+ ;;
+ beos*)
+ ;;
+ bsdi[45]*)
+ ;;
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32*)
+ shrext=.dll
+ ;;
+ darwin* | rhapsody*)
+ shrext=.dylib
+ ;;
+ dgux*)
+ ;;
+ freebsd1*)
+ ;;
+ kfreebsd*-gnu)
+ ;;
+ freebsd*)
+ ;;
+ gnu*)
+ ;;
+ hpux9* | hpux10* | hpux11*)
+ case "$host_cpu" in
+ ia64*)
+ shrext=.so
+ ;;
+ hppa*64*)
+ shrext=.sl
+ ;;
+ *)
+ shrext=.sl
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ irix5* | irix6* | nonstopux*)
+ case "$host_os" in
+ irix5* | nonstopux*)
+ libsuff= shlibsuff=
+ ;;
+ *)
+ case $LD in
+ *-32|*"-32 "|*-melf32bsmip|*"-melf32bsmip ") libsuff= shlibsuff= ;;
+ *-n32|*"-n32 "|*-melf32bmipn32|*"-melf32bmipn32 ") libsuff=32 shlibsuff=N32 ;;
+ *-64|*"-64 "|*-melf64bmip|*"-melf64bmip ") libsuff=64 shlibsuff=64 ;;
+ *) libsuff= shlibsuff= ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ linux*oldld* | linux*aout* | linux*coff*)
+ ;;
+ linux*)
+ ;;
+ knetbsd*-gnu)
+ ;;
+ netbsd*)
+ ;;
+ newsos6)
+ ;;
+ nto-qnx*)
+ ;;
+ openbsd*)
+ ;;
+ os2*)
+ libname_spec='$name'
+ shrext=.dll
+ ;;
+ osf3* | osf4* | osf5*)
+ ;;
+ sco3.2v5*)
+ ;;
+ solaris*)
+ ;;
+ sunos4*)
+ ;;
+ sysv4 | sysv4.2uw2* | sysv4.3* | sysv5*)
+ ;;
+ sysv4*MP*)
+ ;;
+ uts4*)
+ ;;
+esac
+
+sed_quote_subst='s/\(["`$\\]\)/\\\1/g'
+escaped_wl=`echo "X$wl" | sed -e 's/^X//' -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+shlibext=`echo "$shrext" | sed -e 's,^\.,,'`
+escaped_hardcode_libdir_flag_spec=`echo "X$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec" | sed -e 's/^X//' -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+
+LC_ALL=C sed -e 's/^\([a-zA-Z0-9_]*\)=/acl_cv_\1=/' <<EOF
+
+# How to pass a linker flag through the compiler.
+wl="$escaped_wl"
+
+# Static library suffix (normally "a").
+libext="$libext"
+
+# Shared library suffix (normally "so").
+shlibext="$shlibext"
+
+# Flag to hardcode \$libdir into a binary during linking.
+# This must work even if \$libdir does not exist.
+hardcode_libdir_flag_spec="$escaped_hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"
+
+# Whether we need a single -rpath flag with a separated argument.
+hardcode_libdir_separator="$hardcode_libdir_separator"
+
+# Set to yes if using DIR/libNAME.so during linking hardcodes DIR into the
+# resulting binary.
+hardcode_direct="$hardcode_direct"
+
+# Set to yes if using the -LDIR flag during linking hardcodes DIR into the
+# resulting binary.
+hardcode_minus_L="$hardcode_minus_L"
+
+EOF
diff --git a/config/depcomp b/config/depcomp
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..04701da5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/depcomp
@@ -0,0 +1,530 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# depcomp - compile a program generating dependencies as side-effects
+
+scriptversion=2005-07-09.11
+
+# Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
+# 02110-1301, USA.
+
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+# Originally written by Alexandre Oliva <oliva@dcc.unicamp.br>.
+
+case $1 in
+ '')
+ echo "$0: No command. Try \`$0 --help' for more information." 1>&2
+ exit 1;
+ ;;
+ -h | --h*)
+ cat <<\EOF
+Usage: depcomp [--help] [--version] PROGRAM [ARGS]
+
+Run PROGRAMS ARGS to compile a file, generating dependencies
+as side-effects.
+
+Environment variables:
+ depmode Dependency tracking mode.
+ source Source file read by `PROGRAMS ARGS'.
+ object Object file output by `PROGRAMS ARGS'.
+ DEPDIR directory where to store dependencies.
+ depfile Dependency file to output.
+ tmpdepfile Temporary file to use when outputing dependencies.
+ libtool Whether libtool is used (yes/no).
+
+Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>.
+EOF
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ -v | --v*)
+ echo "depcomp $scriptversion"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+esac
+
+if test -z "$depmode" || test -z "$source" || test -z "$object"; then
+ echo "depcomp: Variables source, object and depmode must be set" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+# Dependencies for sub/bar.o or sub/bar.obj go into sub/.deps/bar.Po.
+depfile=${depfile-`echo "$object" |
+ sed 's|[^\\/]*$|'${DEPDIR-.deps}'/&|;s|\.\([^.]*\)$|.P\1|;s|Pobj$|Po|'`}
+tmpdepfile=${tmpdepfile-`echo "$depfile" | sed 's/\.\([^.]*\)$/.T\1/'`}
+
+rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+
+# Some modes work just like other modes, but use different flags. We
+# parameterize here, but still list the modes in the big case below,
+# to make depend.m4 easier to write. Note that we *cannot* use a case
+# here, because this file can only contain one case statement.
+if test "$depmode" = hp; then
+ # HP compiler uses -M and no extra arg.
+ gccflag=-M
+ depmode=gcc
+fi
+
+if test "$depmode" = dashXmstdout; then
+ # This is just like dashmstdout with a different argument.
+ dashmflag=-xM
+ depmode=dashmstdout
+fi
+
+case "$depmode" in
+gcc3)
+## gcc 3 implements dependency tracking that does exactly what
+## we want. Yay! Note: for some reason libtool 1.4 doesn't like
+## it if -MD -MP comes after the -MF stuff. Hmm.
+ "$@" -MT "$object" -MD -MP -MF "$tmpdepfile"
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -eq 0; then :
+ else
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+ mv "$tmpdepfile" "$depfile"
+ ;;
+
+gcc)
+## There are various ways to get dependency output from gcc. Here's
+## why we pick this rather obscure method:
+## - Don't want to use -MD because we'd like the dependencies to end
+## up in a subdir. Having to rename by hand is ugly.
+## (We might end up doing this anyway to support other compilers.)
+## - The DEPENDENCIES_OUTPUT environment variable makes gcc act like
+## -MM, not -M (despite what the docs say).
+## - Using -M directly means running the compiler twice (even worse
+## than renaming).
+ if test -z "$gccflag"; then
+ gccflag=-MD,
+ fi
+ "$@" -Wp,"$gccflag$tmpdepfile"
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -eq 0; then :
+ else
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
+ alpha=ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZabcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz
+## The second -e expression handles DOS-style file names with drive letters.
+ sed -e 's/^[^:]*: / /' \
+ -e 's/^['$alpha']:\/[^:]*: / /' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
+## This next piece of magic avoids the `deleted header file' problem.
+## The problem is that when a header file which appears in a .P file
+## is deleted, the dependency causes make to die (because there is
+## typically no way to rebuild the header). We avoid this by adding
+## dummy dependencies for each header file. Too bad gcc doesn't do
+## this for us directly.
+ tr ' ' '
+' < "$tmpdepfile" |
+## Some versions of gcc put a space before the `:'. On the theory
+## that the space means something, we add a space to the output as
+## well.
+## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
+## correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
+ sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+hp)
+ # This case exists only to let depend.m4 do its work. It works by
+ # looking at the text of this script. This case will never be run,
+ # since it is checked for above.
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+
+sgi)
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ "$@" "-Wp,-MDupdate,$tmpdepfile"
+ else
+ "$@" -MDupdate "$tmpdepfile"
+ fi
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -eq 0; then :
+ else
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+
+ if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then # yes, the sourcefile depend on other files
+ echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
+
+ # Clip off the initial element (the dependent). Don't try to be
+ # clever and replace this with sed code, as IRIX sed won't handle
+ # lines with more than a fixed number of characters (4096 in
+ # IRIX 6.2 sed, 8192 in IRIX 6.5). We also remove comment lines;
+ # the IRIX cc adds comments like `#:fec' to the end of the
+ # dependency line.
+ tr ' ' '
+' < "$tmpdepfile" \
+ | sed -e 's/^.*\.o://' -e 's/#.*$//' -e '/^$/ d' | \
+ tr '
+' ' ' >> $depfile
+ echo >> $depfile
+
+ # The second pass generates a dummy entry for each header file.
+ tr ' ' '
+' < "$tmpdepfile" \
+ | sed -e 's/^.*\.o://' -e 's/#.*$//' -e '/^$/ d' -e 's/$/:/' \
+ >> $depfile
+ else
+ # The sourcefile does not contain any dependencies, so just
+ # store a dummy comment line, to avoid errors with the Makefile
+ # "include basename.Plo" scheme.
+ echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
+ fi
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+aix)
+ # The C for AIX Compiler uses -M and outputs the dependencies
+ # in a .u file. In older versions, this file always lives in the
+ # current directory. Also, the AIX compiler puts `$object:' at the
+ # start of each line; $object doesn't have directory information.
+ # Version 6 uses the directory in both cases.
+ stripped=`echo "$object" | sed 's/\(.*\)\..*$/\1/'`
+ tmpdepfile="$stripped.u"
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ "$@" -Wc,-M
+ else
+ "$@" -M
+ fi
+ stat=$?
+
+ if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then :
+ else
+ stripped=`echo "$stripped" | sed 's,^.*/,,'`
+ tmpdepfile="$stripped.u"
+ fi
+
+ if test $stat -eq 0; then :
+ else
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+
+ if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then
+ outname="$stripped.o"
+ # Each line is of the form `foo.o: dependent.h'.
+ # Do two passes, one to just change these to
+ # `$object: dependent.h' and one to simply `dependent.h:'.
+ sed -e "s,^$outname:,$object :," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ sed -e "s,^$outname: \(.*\)$,\1:," < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
+ else
+ # The sourcefile does not contain any dependencies, so just
+ # store a dummy comment line, to avoid errors with the Makefile
+ # "include basename.Plo" scheme.
+ echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
+ fi
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+icc)
+ # Intel's C compiler understands `-MD -MF file'. However on
+ # icc -MD -MF foo.d -c -o sub/foo.o sub/foo.c
+ # ICC 7.0 will fill foo.d with something like
+ # foo.o: sub/foo.c
+ # foo.o: sub/foo.h
+ # which is wrong. We want:
+ # sub/foo.o: sub/foo.c
+ # sub/foo.o: sub/foo.h
+ # sub/foo.c:
+ # sub/foo.h:
+ # ICC 7.1 will output
+ # foo.o: sub/foo.c sub/foo.h
+ # and will wrap long lines using \ :
+ # foo.o: sub/foo.c ... \
+ # sub/foo.h ... \
+ # ...
+
+ "$@" -MD -MF "$tmpdepfile"
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -eq 0; then :
+ else
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ # Each line is of the form `foo.o: dependent.h',
+ # or `foo.o: dep1.h dep2.h \', or ` dep3.h dep4.h \'.
+ # Do two passes, one to just change these to
+ # `$object: dependent.h' and one to simply `dependent.h:'.
+ sed "s,^[^:]*:,$object :," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ # Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
+ # correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
+ sed 's,^[^:]*: \(.*\)$,\1,;s/^\\$//;/^$/d;/:$/d' < "$tmpdepfile" |
+ sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+tru64)
+ # The Tru64 compiler uses -MD to generate dependencies as a side
+ # effect. `cc -MD -o foo.o ...' puts the dependencies into `foo.o.d'.
+ # At least on Alpha/Redhat 6.1, Compaq CCC V6.2-504 seems to put
+ # dependencies in `foo.d' instead, so we check for that too.
+ # Subdirectories are respected.
+ dir=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|/[^/]*$|/|'`
+ test "x$dir" = "x$object" && dir=
+ base=`echo "$object" | sed -e 's|^.*/||' -e 's/\.o$//' -e 's/\.lo$//'`
+
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ # With Tru64 cc, shared objects can also be used to make a
+ # static library. This mecanism is used in libtool 1.4 series to
+ # handle both shared and static libraries in a single compilation.
+ # With libtool 1.4, dependencies were output in $dir.libs/$base.lo.d.
+ #
+ # With libtool 1.5 this exception was removed, and libtool now
+ # generates 2 separate objects for the 2 libraries. These two
+ # compilations output dependencies in in $dir.libs/$base.o.d and
+ # in $dir$base.o.d. We have to check for both files, because
+ # one of the two compilations can be disabled. We should prefer
+ # $dir$base.o.d over $dir.libs/$base.o.d because the latter is
+ # automatically cleaned when .libs/ is deleted, while ignoring
+ # the former would cause a distcleancheck panic.
+ tmpdepfile1=$dir.libs/$base.lo.d # libtool 1.4
+ tmpdepfile2=$dir$base.o.d # libtool 1.5
+ tmpdepfile3=$dir.libs/$base.o.d # libtool 1.5
+ tmpdepfile4=$dir.libs/$base.d # Compaq CCC V6.2-504
+ "$@" -Wc,-MD
+ else
+ tmpdepfile1=$dir$base.o.d
+ tmpdepfile2=$dir$base.d
+ tmpdepfile3=$dir$base.d
+ tmpdepfile4=$dir$base.d
+ "$@" -MD
+ fi
+
+ stat=$?
+ if test $stat -eq 0; then :
+ else
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3" "$tmpdepfile4"
+ exit $stat
+ fi
+
+ for tmpdepfile in "$tmpdepfile1" "$tmpdepfile2" "$tmpdepfile3" "$tmpdepfile4"
+ do
+ test -f "$tmpdepfile" && break
+ done
+ if test -f "$tmpdepfile"; then
+ sed -e "s,^.*\.[a-z]*:,$object:," < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ # That's a tab and a space in the [].
+ sed -e 's,^.*\.[a-z]*:[ ]*,,' -e 's,$,:,' < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
+ else
+ echo "#dummy" > "$depfile"
+ fi
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+#nosideeffect)
+ # This comment above is used by automake to tell side-effect
+ # dependency tracking mechanisms from slower ones.
+
+dashmstdout)
+ # Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must*
+ # always write the preprocessed file to stdout, regardless of -o.
+ "$@" || exit $?
+
+ # Remove the call to Libtool.
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do
+ shift
+ done
+ shift
+ fi
+
+ # Remove `-o $object'.
+ IFS=" "
+ for arg
+ do
+ case $arg in
+ -o)
+ shift
+ ;;
+ $object)
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set fnord "$@" "$arg"
+ shift # fnord
+ shift # $arg
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ test -z "$dashmflag" && dashmflag=-M
+ # Require at least two characters before searching for `:'
+ # in the target name. This is to cope with DOS-style filenames:
+ # a dependency such as `c:/foo/bar' could be seen as target `c' otherwise.
+ "$@" $dashmflag |
+ sed 's:^[ ]*[^: ][^:][^:]*\:[ ]*:'"$object"'\: :' > "$tmpdepfile"
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ cat < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ tr ' ' '
+' < "$tmpdepfile" | \
+## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
+## correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
+ sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+dashXmstdout)
+ # This case only exists to satisfy depend.m4. It is never actually
+ # run, as this mode is specially recognized in the preamble.
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+
+makedepend)
+ "$@" || exit $?
+ # Remove any Libtool call
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do
+ shift
+ done
+ shift
+ fi
+ # X makedepend
+ shift
+ cleared=no
+ for arg in "$@"; do
+ case $cleared in
+ no)
+ set ""; shift
+ cleared=yes ;;
+ esac
+ case "$arg" in
+ -D*|-I*)
+ set fnord "$@" "$arg"; shift ;;
+ # Strip any option that makedepend may not understand. Remove
+ # the object too, otherwise makedepend will parse it as a source file.
+ -*|$object)
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set fnord "$@" "$arg"; shift ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ obj_suffix="`echo $object | sed 's/^.*\././'`"
+ touch "$tmpdepfile"
+ ${MAKEDEPEND-makedepend} -o"$obj_suffix" -f"$tmpdepfile" "$@"
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ cat < "$tmpdepfile" > "$depfile"
+ sed '1,2d' "$tmpdepfile" | tr ' ' '
+' | \
+## Some versions of the HPUX 10.20 sed can't process this invocation
+## correctly. Breaking it into two sed invocations is a workaround.
+ sed -e 's/^\\$//' -e '/^$/d' -e '/:$/d' | sed -e 's/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile" "$tmpdepfile".bak
+ ;;
+
+cpp)
+ # Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must*
+ # always write the preprocessed file to stdout.
+ "$@" || exit $?
+
+ # Remove the call to Libtool.
+ if test "$libtool" = yes; then
+ while test $1 != '--mode=compile'; do
+ shift
+ done
+ shift
+ fi
+
+ # Remove `-o $object'.
+ IFS=" "
+ for arg
+ do
+ case $arg in
+ -o)
+ shift
+ ;;
+ $object)
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set fnord "$@" "$arg"
+ shift # fnord
+ shift # $arg
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ "$@" -E |
+ sed -n -e '/^# [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' \
+ -e '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)".*/ s:: \1 \\:p' |
+ sed '$ s: \\$::' > "$tmpdepfile"
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
+ cat < "$tmpdepfile" >> "$depfile"
+ sed < "$tmpdepfile" '/^$/d;s/^ //;s/ \\$//;s/$/ :/' >> "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+msvisualcpp)
+ # Important note: in order to support this mode, a compiler *must*
+ # always write the preprocessed file to stdout, regardless of -o,
+ # because we must use -o when running libtool.
+ "$@" || exit $?
+ IFS=" "
+ for arg
+ do
+ case "$arg" in
+ "-Gm"|"/Gm"|"-Gi"|"/Gi"|"-ZI"|"/ZI")
+ set fnord "$@"
+ shift
+ shift
+ ;;
+ *)
+ set fnord "$@" "$arg"
+ shift
+ shift
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ "$@" -E |
+ sed -n '/^#line [0-9][0-9]* "\([^"]*\)"/ s::echo "`cygpath -u \\"\1\\"`":p' | sort | uniq > "$tmpdepfile"
+ rm -f "$depfile"
+ echo "$object : \\" > "$depfile"
+ . "$tmpdepfile" | sed 's% %\\ %g' | sed -n '/^\(.*\)$/ s:: \1 \\:p' >> "$depfile"
+ echo " " >> "$depfile"
+ . "$tmpdepfile" | sed 's% %\\ %g' | sed -n '/^\(.*\)$/ s::\1\::p' >> "$depfile"
+ rm -f "$tmpdepfile"
+ ;;
+
+none)
+ exec "$@"
+ ;;
+
+*)
+ echo "Unknown depmode $depmode" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+esac
+
+exit 0
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode: shell-script
+# sh-indentation: 2
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# End:
diff --git a/config/include-Makefile.am b/config/include-Makefile.am
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..f9327c7a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/include-Makefile.am
@@ -0,0 +1,12 @@
+usrbindir = $(prefix)/usr/bin
+usrsbindir = $(prefix)/usr/sbin
+datadir = $(prefix)/usr/share
+infodir = $(datadir)/info
+mandir = $(datadir)/man
+
+AM_CPPFLAGS = -include ../config.h -I$(top_srcdir)/include
+
+DEFAULT_INCLUDES =
+
+DEFS = -DLOCALEDIR=\"$(localedir)\" @DEFS@
+
diff --git a/config/install-sh b/config/install-sh
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..4d4a9519
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/install-sh
@@ -0,0 +1,323 @@
+#!/bin/sh
+# install - install a program, script, or datafile
+
+scriptversion=2005-05-14.22
+
+# This originates from X11R5 (mit/util/scripts/install.sh), which was
+# later released in X11R6 (xc/config/util/install.sh) with the
+# following copyright and license.
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1994 X Consortium
+#
+# Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to any person obtaining a copy
+# of this software and associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
+# deal in the Software without restriction, including without limitation the
+# rights to use, copy, modify, merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or
+# sell copies of the Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is
+# furnished to do so, subject to the following conditions:
+#
+# The above copyright notice and this permission notice shall be included in
+# all copies or substantial portions of the Software.
+#
+# THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
+# IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
+# FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
+# X CONSORTIUM BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
+# AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNEC-
+# TION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
+#
+# Except as contained in this notice, the name of the X Consortium shall not
+# be used in advertising or otherwise to promote the sale, use or other deal-
+# ings in this Software without prior written authorization from the X Consor-
+# tium.
+#
+#
+# FSF changes to this file are in the public domain.
+#
+# Calling this script install-sh is preferred over install.sh, to prevent
+# `make' implicit rules from creating a file called install from it
+# when there is no Makefile.
+#
+# This script is compatible with the BSD install script, but was written
+# from scratch. It can only install one file at a time, a restriction
+# shared with many OS's install programs.
+
+# set DOITPROG to echo to test this script
+
+# Don't use :- since 4.3BSD and earlier shells don't like it.
+doit="${DOITPROG-}"
+
+# put in absolute paths if you don't have them in your path; or use env. vars.
+
+mvprog="${MVPROG-mv}"
+cpprog="${CPPROG-cp}"
+chmodprog="${CHMODPROG-chmod}"
+chownprog="${CHOWNPROG-chown}"
+chgrpprog="${CHGRPPROG-chgrp}"
+stripprog="${STRIPPROG-strip}"
+rmprog="${RMPROG-rm}"
+mkdirprog="${MKDIRPROG-mkdir}"
+
+chmodcmd="$chmodprog 0755"
+chowncmd=
+chgrpcmd=
+stripcmd=
+rmcmd="$rmprog -f"
+mvcmd="$mvprog"
+src=
+dst=
+dir_arg=
+dstarg=
+no_target_directory=
+
+usage="Usage: $0 [OPTION]... [-T] SRCFILE DSTFILE
+ or: $0 [OPTION]... SRCFILES... DIRECTORY
+ or: $0 [OPTION]... -t DIRECTORY SRCFILES...
+ or: $0 [OPTION]... -d DIRECTORIES...
+
+In the 1st form, copy SRCFILE to DSTFILE.
+In the 2nd and 3rd, copy all SRCFILES to DIRECTORY.
+In the 4th, create DIRECTORIES.
+
+Options:
+-c (ignored)
+-d create directories instead of installing files.
+-g GROUP $chgrpprog installed files to GROUP.
+-m MODE $chmodprog installed files to MODE.
+-o USER $chownprog installed files to USER.
+-s $stripprog installed files.
+-t DIRECTORY install into DIRECTORY.
+-T report an error if DSTFILE is a directory.
+--help display this help and exit.
+--version display version info and exit.
+
+Environment variables override the default commands:
+ CHGRPPROG CHMODPROG CHOWNPROG CPPROG MKDIRPROG MVPROG RMPROG STRIPPROG
+"
+
+while test -n "$1"; do
+ case $1 in
+ -c) shift
+ continue;;
+
+ -d) dir_arg=true
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ -g) chgrpcmd="$chgrpprog $2"
+ shift
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ --help) echo "$usage"; exit $?;;
+
+ -m) chmodcmd="$chmodprog $2"
+ shift
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ -o) chowncmd="$chownprog $2"
+ shift
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ -s) stripcmd=$stripprog
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ -t) dstarg=$2
+ shift
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ -T) no_target_directory=true
+ shift
+ continue;;
+
+ --version) echo "$0 $scriptversion"; exit $?;;
+
+ *) # When -d is used, all remaining arguments are directories to create.
+ # When -t is used, the destination is already specified.
+ test -n "$dir_arg$dstarg" && break
+ # Otherwise, the last argument is the destination. Remove it from $@.
+ for arg
+ do
+ if test -n "$dstarg"; then
+ # $@ is not empty: it contains at least $arg.
+ set fnord "$@" "$dstarg"
+ shift # fnord
+ fi
+ shift # arg
+ dstarg=$arg
+ done
+ break;;
+ esac
+done
+
+if test -z "$1"; then
+ if test -z "$dir_arg"; then
+ echo "$0: no input file specified." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ # It's OK to call `install-sh -d' without argument.
+ # This can happen when creating conditional directories.
+ exit 0
+fi
+
+for src
+do
+ # Protect names starting with `-'.
+ case $src in
+ -*) src=./$src ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
+ dst=$src
+ src=
+
+ if test -d "$dst"; then
+ mkdircmd=:
+ chmodcmd=
+ else
+ mkdircmd=$mkdirprog
+ fi
+ else
+ # Waiting for this to be detected by the "$cpprog $src $dsttmp" command
+ # might cause directories to be created, which would be especially bad
+ # if $src (and thus $dsttmp) contains '*'.
+ if test ! -f "$src" && test ! -d "$src"; then
+ echo "$0: $src does not exist." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+
+ if test -z "$dstarg"; then
+ echo "$0: no destination specified." >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+
+ dst=$dstarg
+ # Protect names starting with `-'.
+ case $dst in
+ -*) dst=./$dst ;;
+ esac
+
+ # If destination is a directory, append the input filename; won't work
+ # if double slashes aren't ignored.
+ if test -d "$dst"; then
+ if test -n "$no_target_directory"; then
+ echo "$0: $dstarg: Is a directory" >&2
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ dst=$dst/`basename "$src"`
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # This sed command emulates the dirname command.
+ dstdir=`echo "$dst" | sed -e 's,/*$,,;s,[^/]*$,,;s,/*$,,;s,^$,.,'`
+
+ # Make sure that the destination directory exists.
+
+ # Skip lots of stat calls in the usual case.
+ if test ! -d "$dstdir"; then
+ defaultIFS='
+ '
+ IFS="${IFS-$defaultIFS}"
+
+ oIFS=$IFS
+ # Some sh's can't handle IFS=/ for some reason.
+ IFS='%'
+ set x `echo "$dstdir" | sed -e 's@/@%@g' -e 's@^%@/@'`
+ shift
+ IFS=$oIFS
+
+ pathcomp=
+
+ while test $# -ne 0 ; do
+ pathcomp=$pathcomp$1
+ shift
+ if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
+ $mkdirprog "$pathcomp"
+ # mkdir can fail with a `File exist' error in case several
+ # install-sh are creating the directory concurrently. This
+ # is OK.
+ test -d "$pathcomp" || exit
+ fi
+ pathcomp=$pathcomp/
+ done
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$dir_arg"; then
+ $doit $mkdircmd "$dst" \
+ && { test -z "$chowncmd" || $doit $chowncmd "$dst"; } \
+ && { test -z "$chgrpcmd" || $doit $chgrpcmd "$dst"; } \
+ && { test -z "$stripcmd" || $doit $stripcmd "$dst"; } \
+ && { test -z "$chmodcmd" || $doit $chmodcmd "$dst"; }
+
+ else
+ dstfile=`basename "$dst"`
+
+ # Make a couple of temp file names in the proper directory.
+ dsttmp=$dstdir/_inst.$$_
+ rmtmp=$dstdir/_rm.$$_
+
+ # Trap to clean up those temp files at exit.
+ trap 'ret=$?; rm -f "$dsttmp" "$rmtmp" && exit $ret' 0
+ trap '(exit $?); exit' 1 2 13 15
+
+ # Copy the file name to the temp name.
+ $doit $cpprog "$src" "$dsttmp" &&
+
+ # and set any options; do chmod last to preserve setuid bits.
+ #
+ # If any of these fail, we abort the whole thing. If we want to
+ # ignore errors from any of these, just make sure not to ignore
+ # errors from the above "$doit $cpprog $src $dsttmp" command.
+ #
+ { test -z "$chowncmd" || $doit $chowncmd "$dsttmp"; } \
+ && { test -z "$chgrpcmd" || $doit $chgrpcmd "$dsttmp"; } \
+ && { test -z "$stripcmd" || $doit $stripcmd "$dsttmp"; } \
+ && { test -z "$chmodcmd" || $doit $chmodcmd "$dsttmp"; } &&
+
+ # Now rename the file to the real destination.
+ { $doit $mvcmd -f "$dsttmp" "$dstdir/$dstfile" 2>/dev/null \
+ || {
+ # The rename failed, perhaps because mv can't rename something else
+ # to itself, or perhaps because mv is so ancient that it does not
+ # support -f.
+
+ # Now remove or move aside any old file at destination location.
+ # We try this two ways since rm can't unlink itself on some
+ # systems and the destination file might be busy for other
+ # reasons. In this case, the final cleanup might fail but the new
+ # file should still install successfully.
+ {
+ if test -f "$dstdir/$dstfile"; then
+ $doit $rmcmd -f "$dstdir/$dstfile" 2>/dev/null \
+ || $doit $mvcmd -f "$dstdir/$dstfile" "$rmtmp" 2>/dev/null \
+ || {
+ echo "$0: cannot unlink or rename $dstdir/$dstfile" >&2
+ (exit 1); exit 1
+ }
+ else
+ :
+ fi
+ } &&
+
+ # Now rename the file to the real destination.
+ $doit $mvcmd "$dsttmp" "$dstdir/$dstfile"
+ }
+ }
+ fi || { (exit 1); exit 1; }
+done
+
+# The final little trick to "correctly" pass the exit status to the exit trap.
+{
+ (exit 0); exit 0
+}
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# End:
diff --git a/config/ltmain.sh b/config/ltmain.sh
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..1a224ac2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/ltmain.sh
@@ -0,0 +1,6426 @@
+# ltmain.sh - Provide generalized library-building support services.
+# NOTE: Changing this file will not affect anything until you rerun configure.
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2003, 2004
+# Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Originally by Gordon Matzigkeit <gord@gnu.ai.mit.edu>, 1996
+#
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or
+# (at your option) any later version.
+#
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but
+# WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+# General Public License for more details.
+#
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA.
+#
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+basename="s,^.*/,,g"
+
+# Work around backward compatibility issue on IRIX 6.5. On IRIX 6.4+, sh
+# is ksh but when the shell is invoked as "sh" and the current value of
+# the _XPG environment variable is not equal to 1 (one), the special
+# positional parameter $0, within a function call, is the name of the
+# function.
+progpath="$0"
+
+# The name of this program:
+progname=`echo "$progpath" | $SED $basename`
+modename="$progname"
+
+# Global variables:
+EXIT_SUCCESS=0
+EXIT_FAILURE=1
+
+PROGRAM=ltmain.sh
+PACKAGE=libtool
+VERSION=1.5.6
+TIMESTAMP=" (1.1220.2.95 2004/04/11 05:50:42) Debian$Rev: 224 $"
+
+
+# Check that we have a working $echo.
+if test "X$1" = X--no-reexec; then
+ # Discard the --no-reexec flag, and continue.
+ shift
+elif test "X$1" = X--fallback-echo; then
+ # Avoid inline document here, it may be left over
+ :
+elif test "X`($echo '\t') 2>/dev/null`" = 'X\t'; then
+ # Yippee, $echo works!
+ :
+else
+ # Restart under the correct shell, and then maybe $echo will work.
+ exec $SHELL "$progpath" --no-reexec ${1+"$@"}
+fi
+
+if test "X$1" = X--fallback-echo; then
+ # used as fallback echo
+ shift
+ cat <<EOF
+$*
+EOF
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+fi
+
+default_mode=
+help="Try \`$progname --help' for more information."
+magic="%%%MAGIC variable%%%"
+mkdir="mkdir"
+mv="mv -f"
+rm="rm -f"
+
+# Sed substitution that helps us do robust quoting. It backslashifies
+# metacharacters that are still active within double-quoted strings.
+Xsed="${SED}"' -e 1s/^X//'
+sed_quote_subst='s/\([\\`\\"$\\\\]\)/\\\1/g'
+# test EBCDIC or ASCII
+case `echo A|tr A '\301'` in
+ A) # EBCDIC based system
+ SP2NL="tr '\100' '\n'"
+ NL2SP="tr '\r\n' '\100\100'"
+ ;;
+ *) # Assume ASCII based system
+ SP2NL="tr '\040' '\012'"
+ NL2SP="tr '\015\012' '\040\040'"
+ ;;
+esac
+
+# NLS nuisances.
+# Only set LANG and LC_ALL to C if already set.
+# These must not be set unconditionally because not all systems understand
+# e.g. LANG=C (notably SCO).
+# We save the old values to restore during execute mode.
+if test "${LC_ALL+set}" = set; then
+ save_LC_ALL="$LC_ALL"; LC_ALL=C; export LC_ALL
+fi
+if test "${LANG+set}" = set; then
+ save_LANG="$LANG"; LANG=C; export LANG
+fi
+
+# Make sure IFS has a sensible default
+: ${IFS="
+"}
+
+if test "$build_libtool_libs" != yes && test "$build_old_libs" != yes; then
+ $echo "$modename: not configured to build any kind of library" 1>&2
+ $echo "Fatal configuration error. See the $PACKAGE docs for more information." 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+fi
+
+# Global variables.
+mode=$default_mode
+nonopt=
+prev=
+prevopt=
+run=
+show="$echo"
+show_help=
+execute_dlfiles=
+lo2o="s/\\.lo\$/.${objext}/"
+o2lo="s/\\.${objext}\$/.lo/"
+
+#####################################
+# Shell function definitions:
+# This seems to be the best place for them
+
+# func_win32_libid arg
+# return the library type of file 'arg'
+#
+# Need a lot of goo to handle *both* DLLs and import libs
+# Has to be a shell function in order to 'eat' the argument
+# that is supplied when $file_magic_command is called.
+func_win32_libid () {
+ win32_libid_type="unknown"
+ win32_fileres=`file -L $1 2>/dev/null`
+ case $win32_fileres in
+ *ar\ archive\ import\ library*) # definitely import
+ win32_libid_type="x86 archive import"
+ ;;
+ *ar\ archive*) # could be an import, or static
+ if eval $OBJDUMP -f $1 | $SED -e '10q' 2>/dev/null | \
+ $EGREP -e 'file format pe-i386(.*architecture: i386)?' >/dev/null ; then
+ win32_nmres=`eval $NM -f posix -A $1 | \
+ sed -n -e '1,100{/ I /{x;/import/!{s/^/import/;h;p;};x;};}'`
+ if test "X$win32_nmres" = "Ximport" ; then
+ win32_libid_type="x86 archive import"
+ else
+ win32_libid_type="x86 archive static"
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+ *DLL*)
+ win32_libid_type="x86 DLL"
+ ;;
+ *executable*) # but shell scripts are "executable" too...
+ case $win32_fileres in
+ *MS\ Windows\ PE\ Intel*)
+ win32_libid_type="x86 DLL"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ $echo $win32_libid_type
+}
+
+
+# func_infer_tag arg
+# Infer tagged configuration to use if any are available and
+# if one wasn't chosen via the "--tag" command line option.
+# Only attempt this if the compiler in the base compile
+# command doesn't match the default compiler.
+# arg is usually of the form 'gcc ...'
+func_infer_tag () {
+ if test -n "$available_tags" && test -z "$tagname"; then
+ CC_quoted=
+ for arg in $CC; do
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ CC_quoted="$CC_quoted $arg"
+ done
+ case $@ in
+ # Blanks in the command may have been stripped by the calling shell,
+ # but not from the CC environment variable when configure was run.
+ " $CC "* | "$CC "* | " `$echo $CC` "* | "`$echo $CC` "* | " $CC_quoted"* | "$CC_quoted "* | " `$echo $CC_quoted` "* | "`$echo $CC_quoted` "*) ;;
+ # Blanks at the start of $base_compile will cause this to fail
+ # if we don't check for them as well.
+ *)
+ for z in $available_tags; do
+ if grep "^# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: $z$" < "$progpath" > /dev/null; then
+ # Evaluate the configuration.
+ eval "`${SED} -n -e '/^# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: '$z'$/,/^# ### END LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: '$z'$/p' < $progpath`"
+ CC_quoted=
+ for arg in $CC; do
+ # Double-quote args containing other shell metacharacters.
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ CC_quoted="$CC_quoted $arg"
+ done
+ case "$@ " in
+ " $CC "* | "$CC "* | " `$echo $CC` "* | "`$echo $CC` "* | " $CC_quoted"* | "$CC_quoted "* | " `$echo $CC_quoted` "* | "`$echo $CC_quoted` "*)
+ # The compiler in the base compile command matches
+ # the one in the tagged configuration.
+ # Assume this is the tagged configuration we want.
+ tagname=$z
+ break
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ done
+ # If $tagname still isn't set, then no tagged configuration
+ # was found and let the user know that the "--tag" command
+ # line option must be used.
+ if test -z "$tagname"; then
+ $echo "$modename: unable to infer tagged configuration"
+ $echo "$modename: specify a tag with \`--tag'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+# else
+# $echo "$modename: using $tagname tagged configuration"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+}
+# End of Shell function definitions
+#####################################
+
+# Darwin sucks
+eval std_shrext=\"$shrext_cmds\"
+
+# Parse our command line options once, thoroughly.
+while test "$#" -gt 0
+do
+ arg="$1"
+ shift
+
+ case $arg in
+ -*=*) optarg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's/[-_a-zA-Z0-9]*=//'` ;;
+ *) optarg= ;;
+ esac
+
+ # If the previous option needs an argument, assign it.
+ if test -n "$prev"; then
+ case $prev in
+ execute_dlfiles)
+ execute_dlfiles="$execute_dlfiles $arg"
+ ;;
+ tag)
+ tagname="$arg"
+ preserve_args="${preserve_args}=$arg"
+
+ # Check whether tagname contains only valid characters
+ case $tagname in
+ *[!-_A-Za-z0-9,/]*)
+ $echo "$progname: invalid tag name: $tagname" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $tagname in
+ CC)
+ # Don't test for the "default" C tag, as we know, it's there, but
+ # not specially marked.
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if grep "^# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: $tagname$" < "$progpath" > /dev/null; then
+ taglist="$taglist $tagname"
+ # Evaluate the configuration.
+ eval "`${SED} -n -e '/^# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: '$tagname'$/,/^# ### END LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: '$tagname'$/p' < $progpath`"
+ else
+ $echo "$progname: ignoring unknown tag $tagname" 1>&2
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ *)
+ eval "$prev=\$arg"
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ prev=
+ prevopt=
+ continue
+ fi
+
+ # Have we seen a non-optional argument yet?
+ case $arg in
+ --help)
+ show_help=yes
+ ;;
+
+ --version)
+ $echo "$PROGRAM (GNU $PACKAGE) $VERSION$TIMESTAMP"
+ $echo
+ $echo "Copyright (C) 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc."
+ $echo "This is free software; see the source for copying conditions. There is NO"
+ $echo "warranty; not even for MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE."
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ --config)
+ ${SED} -e '1,/^# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL CONFIG/d' -e '/^# ### END LIBTOOL CONFIG/,$d' $progpath
+ # Now print the configurations for the tags.
+ for tagname in $taglist; do
+ ${SED} -n -e "/^# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: $tagname$/,/^# ### END LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: $tagname$/p" < "$progpath"
+ done
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ --debug)
+ $echo "$progname: enabling shell trace mode"
+ set -x
+ preserve_args="$preserve_args $arg"
+ ;;
+
+ --dry-run | -n)
+ run=:
+ ;;
+
+ --features)
+ $echo "host: $host"
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ $echo "enable shared libraries"
+ else
+ $echo "disable shared libraries"
+ fi
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = yes; then
+ $echo "enable static libraries"
+ else
+ $echo "disable static libraries"
+ fi
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ --finish) mode="finish" ;;
+
+ --mode) prevopt="--mode" prev=mode ;;
+ --mode=*) mode="$optarg" ;;
+
+ --preserve-dup-deps) duplicate_deps="yes" ;;
+
+ --quiet | --silent)
+ show=:
+ preserve_args="$preserve_args $arg"
+ ;;
+
+ --tag) prevopt="--tag" prev=tag ;;
+ --tag=*)
+ set tag "$optarg" ${1+"$@"}
+ shift
+ prev=tag
+ preserve_args="$preserve_args --tag"
+ ;;
+
+ -dlopen)
+ prevopt="-dlopen"
+ prev=execute_dlfiles
+ ;;
+
+ -*)
+ $echo "$modename: unrecognized option \`$arg'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ nonopt="$arg"
+ break
+ ;;
+ esac
+done
+
+if test -n "$prevopt"; then
+ $echo "$modename: option \`$prevopt' requires an argument" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+fi
+
+# If this variable is set in any of the actions, the command in it
+# will be execed at the end. This prevents here-documents from being
+# left over by shells.
+exec_cmd=
+
+if test -z "$show_help"; then
+
+ # Infer the operation mode.
+ if test -z "$mode"; then
+ $echo "*** Warning: inferring the mode of operation is deprecated." 1>&2
+ $echo "*** Future versions of Libtool will require -mode=MODE be specified." 1>&2
+ case $nonopt in
+ *cc | cc* | *++ | gcc* | *-gcc* | g++* | xlc*)
+ mode=link
+ for arg
+ do
+ case $arg in
+ -c)
+ mode=compile
+ break
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ ;;
+ *db | *dbx | *strace | *truss)
+ mode=execute
+ ;;
+ *install*|cp|mv)
+ mode=install
+ ;;
+ *rm)
+ mode=uninstall
+ ;;
+ *)
+ # If we have no mode, but dlfiles were specified, then do execute mode.
+ test -n "$execute_dlfiles" && mode=execute
+
+ # Just use the default operation mode.
+ if test -z "$mode"; then
+ if test -n "$nonopt"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: cannot infer operation mode from \`$nonopt'" 1>&2
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: warning: cannot infer operation mode without MODE-ARGS" 1>&2
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ # Only execute mode is allowed to have -dlopen flags.
+ if test -n "$execute_dlfiles" && test "$mode" != execute; then
+ $echo "$modename: unrecognized option \`-dlopen'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Change the help message to a mode-specific one.
+ generic_help="$help"
+ help="Try \`$modename --help --mode=$mode' for more information."
+
+ # These modes are in order of execution frequency so that they run quickly.
+ case $mode in
+ # libtool compile mode
+ compile)
+ modename="$modename: compile"
+ # Get the compilation command and the source file.
+ base_compile=
+ srcfile="$nonopt" # always keep a non-empty value in "srcfile"
+ suppress_opt=yes
+ suppress_output=
+ arg_mode=normal
+ libobj=
+ later=
+
+ for arg
+ do
+ case "$arg_mode" in
+ arg )
+ # do not "continue". Instead, add this to base_compile
+ lastarg="$arg"
+ arg_mode=normal
+ ;;
+
+ target )
+ libobj="$arg"
+ arg_mode=normal
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ normal )
+ # Accept any command-line options.
+ case $arg in
+ -o)
+ if test -n "$libobj" ; then
+ $echo "$modename: you cannot specify \`-o' more than once" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ arg_mode=target
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -static | -prefer-pic | -prefer-non-pic)
+ later="$later $arg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -no-suppress)
+ suppress_opt=no
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -Xcompiler)
+ arg_mode=arg # the next one goes into the "base_compile" arg list
+ continue # The current "srcfile" will either be retained or
+ ;; # replaced later. I would guess that would be a bug.
+
+ -Wc,*)
+ args=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "s/^-Wc,//"`
+ lastarg=
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=','
+ for arg in $args; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+
+ # Double-quote args containing other shell metacharacters.
+ # Many Bourne shells cannot handle close brackets correctly
+ # in scan sets, so we specify it separately.
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ lastarg="$lastarg $arg"
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ lastarg=`$echo "X$lastarg" | $Xsed -e "s/^ //"`
+
+ # Add the arguments to base_compile.
+ base_compile="$base_compile $lastarg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ * )
+ # Accept the current argument as the source file.
+ # The previous "srcfile" becomes the current argument.
+ #
+ lastarg="$srcfile"
+ srcfile="$arg"
+ ;;
+ esac # case $arg
+ ;;
+ esac # case $arg_mode
+
+ # Aesthetically quote the previous argument.
+ lastarg=`$echo "X$lastarg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+
+ case $lastarg in
+ # Double-quote args containing other shell metacharacters.
+ # Many Bourne shells cannot handle close brackets correctly
+ # in scan sets, so we specify it separately.
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ lastarg="\"$lastarg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ base_compile="$base_compile $lastarg"
+ done # for arg
+
+ case $arg_mode in
+ arg)
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify an argument for -Xcompile"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ target)
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify a target with \`-o'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ *)
+ # Get the name of the library object.
+ [ -z "$libobj" ] && libobj=`$echo "X$srcfile" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Recognize several different file suffixes.
+ # If the user specifies -o file.o, it is replaced with file.lo
+ xform='[cCFSifmso]'
+ case $libobj in
+ *.ada) xform=ada ;;
+ *.adb) xform=adb ;;
+ *.ads) xform=ads ;;
+ *.asm) xform=asm ;;
+ *.c++) xform=c++ ;;
+ *.cc) xform=cc ;;
+ *.ii) xform=ii ;;
+ *.class) xform=class ;;
+ *.cpp) xform=cpp ;;
+ *.cxx) xform=cxx ;;
+ *.f90) xform=f90 ;;
+ *.for) xform=for ;;
+ *.java) xform=java ;;
+ esac
+
+ libobj=`$echo "X$libobj" | $Xsed -e "s/\.$xform$/.lo/"`
+
+ case $libobj in
+ *.lo) obj=`$echo "X$libobj" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"` ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: cannot determine name of library object from \`$libobj'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ func_infer_tag $base_compile
+
+ for arg in $later; do
+ case $arg in
+ -static)
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -prefer-pic)
+ pic_mode=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -prefer-non-pic)
+ pic_mode=no
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ objname=`$echo "X$obj" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ xdir=`$echo "X$obj" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$xdir" = "X$obj"; then
+ xdir=
+ else
+ xdir=$xdir/
+ fi
+ lobj=${xdir}$objdir/$objname
+
+ if test -z "$base_compile"; then
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify a compilation command" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Delete any leftover library objects.
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = yes; then
+ removelist="$obj $lobj $libobj ${libobj}T"
+ else
+ removelist="$lobj $libobj ${libobj}T"
+ fi
+
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ trap "$run $rm $removelist; exit $EXIT_FAILURE" 1 2 15
+
+ # On Cygwin there's no "real" PIC flag so we must build both object types
+ case $host_os in
+ cygwin* | mingw* | pw32* | os2*)
+ pic_mode=default
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if test "$pic_mode" = no && test "$deplibs_check_method" != pass_all; then
+ # non-PIC code in shared libraries is not supported
+ pic_mode=default
+ fi
+
+ # Calculate the filename of the output object if compiler does
+ # not support -o with -c
+ if test "$compiler_c_o" = no; then
+ output_obj=`$echo "X$srcfile" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%' -e 's%\.[^.]*$%%'`.${objext}
+ lockfile="$output_obj.lock"
+ removelist="$removelist $output_obj $lockfile"
+ trap "$run $rm $removelist; exit $EXIT_FAILURE" 1 2 15
+ else
+ output_obj=
+ need_locks=no
+ lockfile=
+ fi
+
+ # Lock this critical section if it is needed
+ # We use this script file to make the link, it avoids creating a new file
+ if test "$need_locks" = yes; then
+ until $run ln "$progpath" "$lockfile" 2>/dev/null; do
+ $show "Waiting for $lockfile to be removed"
+ sleep 2
+ done
+ elif test "$need_locks" = warn; then
+ if test -f "$lockfile"; then
+ $echo "\
+*** ERROR, $lockfile exists and contains:
+`cat $lockfile 2>/dev/null`
+
+This indicates that another process is trying to use the same
+temporary object file, and libtool could not work around it because
+your compiler does not support \`-c' and \`-o' together. If you
+repeat this compilation, it may succeed, by chance, but you had better
+avoid parallel builds (make -j) in this platform, or get a better
+compiler."
+
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ $echo $srcfile > "$lockfile"
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$fix_srcfile_path"; then
+ eval srcfile=\"$fix_srcfile_path\"
+ fi
+
+ $run $rm "$libobj" "${libobj}T"
+
+ # Create a libtool object file (analogous to a ".la" file),
+ # but don't create it if we're doing a dry run.
+ test -z "$run" && cat > ${libobj}T <<EOF
+# $libobj - a libtool object file
+# Generated by $PROGRAM - GNU $PACKAGE $VERSION$TIMESTAMP
+#
+# Please DO NOT delete this file!
+# It is necessary for linking the library.
+
+# Name of the PIC object.
+EOF
+
+ # Only build a PIC object if we are building libtool libraries.
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ # Without this assignment, base_compile gets emptied.
+ fbsd_hideous_sh_bug=$base_compile
+
+ if test "$pic_mode" != no; then
+ command="$base_compile $srcfile $pic_flag"
+ else
+ # Don't build PIC code
+ command="$base_compile $srcfile"
+ fi
+
+ if test ! -d "${xdir}$objdir"; then
+ $show "$mkdir ${xdir}$objdir"
+ $run $mkdir ${xdir}$objdir
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "${xdir}$objdir"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test -z "$output_obj"; then
+ # Place PIC objects in $objdir
+ command="$command -o $lobj"
+ fi
+
+ $run $rm "$lobj" "$output_obj"
+
+ $show "$command"
+ if $run eval "$command"; then :
+ else
+ test -n "$output_obj" && $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test "$need_locks" = warn &&
+ test "X`cat $lockfile 2>/dev/null`" != "X$srcfile"; then
+ $echo "\
+*** ERROR, $lockfile contains:
+`cat $lockfile 2>/dev/null`
+
+but it should contain:
+$srcfile
+
+This indicates that another process is trying to use the same
+temporary object file, and libtool could not work around it because
+your compiler does not support \`-c' and \`-o' together. If you
+repeat this compilation, it may succeed, by chance, but you had better
+avoid parallel builds (make -j) in this platform, or get a better
+compiler."
+
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Just move the object if needed, then go on to compile the next one
+ if test -n "$output_obj" && test "X$output_obj" != "X$lobj"; then
+ $show "$mv $output_obj $lobj"
+ if $run $mv $output_obj $lobj; then :
+ else
+ error=$?
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $error
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Append the name of the PIC object to the libtool object file.
+ test -z "$run" && cat >> ${libobj}T <<EOF
+pic_object='$objdir/$objname'
+
+EOF
+
+ # Allow error messages only from the first compilation.
+ if test "$suppress_opt" = yes; then
+ suppress_output=' >/dev/null 2>&1'
+ fi
+ else
+ # No PIC object so indicate it doesn't exist in the libtool
+ # object file.
+ test -z "$run" && cat >> ${libobj}T <<EOF
+pic_object=none
+
+EOF
+ fi
+
+ # Only build a position-dependent object if we build old libraries.
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = yes; then
+ if test "$pic_mode" != yes; then
+ # Don't build PIC code
+ command="$base_compile $srcfile"
+ else
+ command="$base_compile $srcfile $pic_flag"
+ fi
+ if test "$compiler_c_o" = yes; then
+ command="$command -o $obj"
+ fi
+
+ # Suppress compiler output if we already did a PIC compilation.
+ command="$command$suppress_output"
+ $run $rm "$obj" "$output_obj"
+ $show "$command"
+ if $run eval "$command"; then :
+ else
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test "$need_locks" = warn &&
+ test "X`cat $lockfile 2>/dev/null`" != "X$srcfile"; then
+ $echo "\
+*** ERROR, $lockfile contains:
+`cat $lockfile 2>/dev/null`
+
+but it should contain:
+$srcfile
+
+This indicates that another process is trying to use the same
+temporary object file, and libtool could not work around it because
+your compiler does not support \`-c' and \`-o' together. If you
+repeat this compilation, it may succeed, by chance, but you had better
+avoid parallel builds (make -j) in this platform, or get a better
+compiler."
+
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Just move the object if needed
+ if test -n "$output_obj" && test "X$output_obj" != "X$obj"; then
+ $show "$mv $output_obj $obj"
+ if $run $mv $output_obj $obj; then :
+ else
+ error=$?
+ $run $rm $removelist
+ exit $error
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Append the name of the non-PIC object the libtool object file.
+ # Only append if the libtool object file exists.
+ test -z "$run" && cat >> ${libobj}T <<EOF
+# Name of the non-PIC object.
+non_pic_object='$objname'
+
+EOF
+ else
+ # Append the name of the non-PIC object the libtool object file.
+ # Only append if the libtool object file exists.
+ test -z "$run" && cat >> ${libobj}T <<EOF
+# Name of the non-PIC object.
+non_pic_object=none
+
+EOF
+ fi
+
+ $run $mv "${libobj}T" "${libobj}"
+
+ # Unlock the critical section if it was locked
+ if test "$need_locks" != no; then
+ $run $rm "$lockfile"
+ fi
+
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ # libtool link mode
+ link | relink)
+ modename="$modename: link"
+ case $host in
+ *-*-cygwin* | *-*-mingw* | *-*-pw32* | *-*-os2*)
+ # It is impossible to link a dll without this setting, and
+ # we shouldn't force the makefile maintainer to figure out
+ # which system we are compiling for in order to pass an extra
+ # flag for every libtool invocation.
+ # allow_undefined=no
+
+ # FIXME: Unfortunately, there are problems with the above when trying
+ # to make a dll which has undefined symbols, in which case not
+ # even a static library is built. For now, we need to specify
+ # -no-undefined on the libtool link line when we can be certain
+ # that all symbols are satisfied, otherwise we get a static library.
+ allow_undefined=yes
+ ;;
+ *)
+ allow_undefined=yes
+ ;;
+ esac
+ libtool_args="$nonopt"
+ base_compile="$nonopt $@"
+ compile_command="$nonopt"
+ finalize_command="$nonopt"
+
+ compile_rpath=
+ finalize_rpath=
+ compile_shlibpath=
+ finalize_shlibpath=
+ convenience=
+ old_convenience=
+ deplibs=
+ old_deplibs=
+ compiler_flags=
+ linker_flags=
+ dllsearchpath=
+ lib_search_path=`pwd`
+ inst_prefix_dir=
+
+ avoid_version=no
+ dlfiles=
+ dlprefiles=
+ dlself=no
+ export_dynamic=no
+ export_symbols=
+ export_symbols_regex=
+ generated=
+ libobjs=
+ ltlibs=
+ module=no
+ no_install=no
+ objs=
+ non_pic_objects=
+ precious_files_regex=
+ prefer_static_libs=no
+ preload=no
+ prev=
+ prevarg=
+ release=
+ rpath=
+ xrpath=
+ perm_rpath=
+ temp_rpath=
+ thread_safe=no
+ vinfo=
+ vinfo_number=no
+
+ func_infer_tag $base_compile
+
+ # We need to know -static, to get the right output filenames.
+ for arg
+ do
+ case $arg in
+ -all-static | -static)
+ if test "X$arg" = "X-all-static"; then
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes && test -z "$link_static_flag"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: complete static linking is impossible in this configuration" 1>&2
+ fi
+ if test -n "$link_static_flag"; then
+ dlopen_self=$dlopen_self_static
+ fi
+ else
+ if test -z "$pic_flag" && test -n "$link_static_flag"; then
+ dlopen_self=$dlopen_self_static
+ fi
+ fi
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ prefer_static_libs=yes
+ break
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ # See if our shared archives depend on static archives.
+ test -n "$old_archive_from_new_cmds" && build_old_libs=yes
+
+ # Go through the arguments, transforming them on the way.
+ while test "$#" -gt 0; do
+ arg="$1"
+ shift
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ qarg=\"`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`\" ### testsuite: skip nested quoting test
+ ;;
+ *) qarg=$arg ;;
+ esac
+ libtool_args="$libtool_args $qarg"
+
+ # If the previous option needs an argument, assign it.
+ if test -n "$prev"; then
+ case $prev in
+ output)
+ compile_command="$compile_command @OUTPUT@"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command @OUTPUT@"
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $prev in
+ dlfiles|dlprefiles)
+ if test "$preload" = no; then
+ # Add the symbol object into the linking commands.
+ compile_command="$compile_command @SYMFILE@"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command @SYMFILE@"
+ preload=yes
+ fi
+ case $arg in
+ *.la | *.lo) ;; # We handle these cases below.
+ force)
+ if test "$dlself" = no; then
+ dlself=needless
+ export_dynamic=yes
+ fi
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ self)
+ if test "$prev" = dlprefiles; then
+ dlself=yes
+ elif test "$prev" = dlfiles && test "$dlopen_self" != yes; then
+ dlself=yes
+ else
+ dlself=needless
+ export_dynamic=yes
+ fi
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if test "$prev" = dlfiles; then
+ dlfiles="$dlfiles $arg"
+ else
+ dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $arg"
+ fi
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ expsyms)
+ export_symbols="$arg"
+ if test ! -f "$arg"; then
+ $echo "$modename: symbol file \`$arg' does not exist"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ expsyms_regex)
+ export_symbols_regex="$arg"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ inst_prefix)
+ inst_prefix_dir="$arg"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ precious_regex)
+ precious_files_regex="$arg"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ release)
+ release="-$arg"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ objectlist)
+ if test -f "$arg"; then
+ save_arg=$arg
+ moreargs=
+ for fil in `cat $save_arg`
+ do
+# moreargs="$moreargs $fil"
+ arg=$fil
+ # A libtool-controlled object.
+
+ # Check to see that this really is a libtool object.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $arg | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ pic_object=
+ non_pic_object=
+
+ # Read the .lo file
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $arg in
+ */* | *\\*) . $arg ;;
+ *) . ./$arg ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test -z "$pic_object" || \
+ test -z "$non_pic_object" ||
+ test "$pic_object" = none && \
+ test "$non_pic_object" = none; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot find name of object for \`$arg'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Extract subdirectory from the argument.
+ xdir=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$xdir" = "X$arg"; then
+ xdir=
+ else
+ xdir="$xdir/"
+ fi
+
+ if test "$pic_object" != none; then
+ # Prepend the subdirectory the object is found in.
+ pic_object="$xdir$pic_object"
+
+ if test "$prev" = dlfiles; then
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes && test "$dlopen_support" = yes; then
+ dlfiles="$dlfiles $pic_object"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ else
+ # If libtool objects are unsupported, then we need to preload.
+ prev=dlprefiles
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # CHECK ME: I think I busted this. -Ossama
+ if test "$prev" = dlprefiles; then
+ # Preload the old-style object.
+ dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $pic_object"
+ prev=
+ fi
+
+ # A PIC object.
+ libobjs="$libobjs $pic_object"
+ arg="$pic_object"
+ fi
+
+ # Non-PIC object.
+ if test "$non_pic_object" != none; then
+ # Prepend the subdirectory the object is found in.
+ non_pic_object="$xdir$non_pic_object"
+
+ # A standard non-PIC object
+ non_pic_objects="$non_pic_objects $non_pic_object"
+ if test -z "$pic_object" || test "$pic_object" = none ; then
+ arg="$non_pic_object"
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ # Only an error if not doing a dry-run.
+ if test -z "$run"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$arg' is not a valid libtool object" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ else
+ # Dry-run case.
+
+ # Extract subdirectory from the argument.
+ xdir=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$xdir" = "X$arg"; then
+ xdir=
+ else
+ xdir="$xdir/"
+ fi
+
+ pic_object=`$echo "X${xdir}${objdir}/${arg}" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+ non_pic_object=`$echo "X${xdir}${arg}" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+ libobjs="$libobjs $pic_object"
+ non_pic_objects="$non_pic_objects $non_pic_object"
+ fi
+ fi
+ done
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: link input file \`$save_arg' does not exist"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ arg=$save_arg
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ rpath | xrpath)
+ # We need an absolute path.
+ case $arg in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: only absolute run-paths are allowed" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if test "$prev" = rpath; then
+ case "$rpath " in
+ *" $arg "*) ;;
+ *) rpath="$rpath $arg" ;;
+ esac
+ else
+ case "$xrpath " in
+ *" $arg "*) ;;
+ *) xrpath="$xrpath $arg" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ xcompiler)
+ compiler_flags="$compiler_flags $qarg"
+ prev=
+ compile_command="$compile_command $qarg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $qarg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+ xlinker)
+ linker_flags="$linker_flags $qarg"
+ compiler_flags="$compiler_flags $wl$qarg"
+ prev=
+ compile_command="$compile_command $wl$qarg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $wl$qarg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+ xcclinker)
+ linker_flags="$linker_flags $qarg"
+ compiler_flags="$compiler_flags $qarg"
+ prev=
+ compile_command="$compile_command $qarg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $qarg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+ shrext)
+ shrext_cmds="$arg"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ *)
+ eval "$prev=\"\$arg\""
+ prev=
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi # test -n "$prev"
+
+ prevarg="$arg"
+
+ case $arg in
+ -all-static)
+ if test -n "$link_static_flag"; then
+ compile_command="$compile_command $link_static_flag"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $link_static_flag"
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -allow-undefined)
+ # FIXME: remove this flag sometime in the future.
+ $echo "$modename: \`-allow-undefined' is deprecated because it is the default" 1>&2
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -avoid-version)
+ avoid_version=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -dlopen)
+ prev=dlfiles
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -dlpreopen)
+ prev=dlprefiles
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -export-dynamic)
+ export_dynamic=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -export-symbols | -export-symbols-regex)
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" || test -n "$export_symbols_regex"; then
+ $echo "$modename: more than one -exported-symbols argument is not allowed"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ if test "X$arg" = "X-export-symbols"; then
+ prev=expsyms
+ else
+ prev=expsyms_regex
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -inst-prefix-dir)
+ prev=inst_prefix
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ # The native IRIX linker understands -LANG:*, -LIST:* and -LNO:*
+ # so, if we see these flags be careful not to treat them like -L
+ -L[A-Z][A-Z]*:*)
+ case $with_gcc/$host in
+ no/*-*-irix* | /*-*-irix*)
+ compile_command="$compile_command $arg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $arg"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -L*)
+ dir=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's/^-L//'`
+ # We need an absolute path.
+ case $dir in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) ;;
+ *)
+ absdir=`cd "$dir" && pwd`
+ if test -z "$absdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot determine absolute directory name of \`$dir'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ dir="$absdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ case "$deplibs " in
+ *" -L$dir "*) ;;
+ *)
+ deplibs="$deplibs -L$dir"
+ lib_search_path="$lib_search_path $dir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ case $host in
+ *-*-cygwin* | *-*-mingw* | *-*-pw32* | *-*-os2*)
+ case :$dllsearchpath: in
+ *":$dir:"*) ;;
+ *) dllsearchpath="$dllsearchpath:$dir";;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -l*)
+ if test "X$arg" = "X-lc" || test "X$arg" = "X-lm"; then
+ case $host in
+ *-*-cygwin* | *-*-pw32* | *-*-beos*)
+ # These systems don't actually have a C or math library (as such)
+ continue
+ ;;
+ *-*-mingw* | *-*-os2*)
+ # These systems don't actually have a C library (as such)
+ test "X$arg" = "X-lc" && continue
+ ;;
+ *-*-openbsd* | *-*-freebsd*)
+ # Do not include libc due to us having libc/libc_r.
+ test "X$arg" = "X-lc" && continue
+ ;;
+ *-*-rhapsody* | *-*-darwin1.[012])
+ # Rhapsody C and math libraries are in the System framework
+ deplibs="$deplibs -framework System"
+ continue
+ esac
+ elif test "X$arg" = "X-lc_r"; then
+ case $host in
+ *-*-openbsd* | *-*-freebsd*)
+ # Do not include libc_r directly, use -pthread flag.
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ deplibs="$deplibs $arg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -mt|-mthreads|-kthread|-Kthread|-pthread|-pthreads|--thread-safe)
+ deplibs="$deplibs $arg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -module)
+ module=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ # gcc -m* arguments should be passed to the linker via $compiler_flags
+ # in order to pass architecture information to the linker
+ # (e.g. 32 vs 64-bit). This may also be accomplished via -Wl,-mfoo
+ # but this is not reliable with gcc because gcc may use -mfoo to
+ # select a different linker, different libraries, etc, while
+ # -Wl,-mfoo simply passes -mfoo to the linker.
+ -m*)
+ # Unknown arguments in both finalize_command and compile_command need
+ # to be aesthetically quoted because they are evaled later.
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ compile_command="$compile_command $arg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $arg"
+ if test "$with_gcc" = "yes" ; then
+ compiler_flags="$compiler_flags $arg"
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -shrext)
+ prev=shrext
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -no-fast-install)
+ fast_install=no
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -no-install)
+ case $host in
+ *-*-cygwin* | *-*-mingw* | *-*-pw32* | *-*-os2*)
+ # The PATH hackery in wrapper scripts is required on Windows
+ # in order for the loader to find any dlls it needs.
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-no-install' is ignored for $host" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: warning: assuming \`-no-fast-install' instead" 1>&2
+ fast_install=no
+ ;;
+ *) no_install=yes ;;
+ esac
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -no-undefined)
+ allow_undefined=no
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -objectlist)
+ prev=objectlist
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -o) prev=output ;;
+
+ -precious-files-regex)
+ prev=precious_regex
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -release)
+ prev=release
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -rpath)
+ prev=rpath
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -R)
+ prev=xrpath
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -R*)
+ dir=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's/^-R//'`
+ # We need an absolute path.
+ case $dir in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: only absolute run-paths are allowed" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+ case "$xrpath " in
+ *" $dir "*) ;;
+ *) xrpath="$xrpath $dir" ;;
+ esac
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -static)
+ # The effects of -static are defined in a previous loop.
+ # We used to do the same as -all-static on platforms that
+ # didn't have a PIC flag, but the assumption that the effects
+ # would be equivalent was wrong. It would break on at least
+ # Digital Unix and AIX.
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -thread-safe)
+ thread_safe=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -version-info)
+ prev=vinfo
+ continue
+ ;;
+ -version-number)
+ prev=vinfo
+ vinfo_number=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -Wc,*)
+ args=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst" -e 's/^-Wc,//'`
+ arg=
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=','
+ for flag in $args; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ case $flag in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ flag="\"$flag\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ arg="$arg $wl$flag"
+ compiler_flags="$compiler_flags $flag"
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "s/^ //"`
+ ;;
+
+ -Wl,*)
+ args=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst" -e 's/^-Wl,//'`
+ arg=
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=','
+ for flag in $args; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ case $flag in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ flag="\"$flag\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ arg="$arg $wl$flag"
+ compiler_flags="$compiler_flags $wl$flag"
+ linker_flags="$linker_flags $flag"
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "s/^ //"`
+ ;;
+
+ -Xcompiler)
+ prev=xcompiler
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -Xlinker)
+ prev=xlinker
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ -XCClinker)
+ prev=xcclinker
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ # Some other compiler flag.
+ -* | +*)
+ # Unknown arguments in both finalize_command and compile_command need
+ # to be aesthetically quoted because they are evaled later.
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+
+ *.$objext)
+ # A standard object.
+ objs="$objs $arg"
+ ;;
+
+ *.lo)
+ # A libtool-controlled object.
+
+ # Check to see that this really is a libtool object.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $arg | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ pic_object=
+ non_pic_object=
+
+ # Read the .lo file
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $arg in
+ */* | *\\*) . $arg ;;
+ *) . ./$arg ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test -z "$pic_object" || \
+ test -z "$non_pic_object" ||
+ test "$pic_object" = none && \
+ test "$non_pic_object" = none; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot find name of object for \`$arg'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Extract subdirectory from the argument.
+ xdir=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$xdir" = "X$arg"; then
+ xdir=
+ else
+ xdir="$xdir/"
+ fi
+
+ if test "$pic_object" != none; then
+ # Prepend the subdirectory the object is found in.
+ pic_object="$xdir$pic_object"
+
+ if test "$prev" = dlfiles; then
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes && test "$dlopen_support" = yes; then
+ dlfiles="$dlfiles $pic_object"
+ prev=
+ continue
+ else
+ # If libtool objects are unsupported, then we need to preload.
+ prev=dlprefiles
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # CHECK ME: I think I busted this. -Ossama
+ if test "$prev" = dlprefiles; then
+ # Preload the old-style object.
+ dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $pic_object"
+ prev=
+ fi
+
+ # A PIC object.
+ libobjs="$libobjs $pic_object"
+ arg="$pic_object"
+ fi
+
+ # Non-PIC object.
+ if test "$non_pic_object" != none; then
+ # Prepend the subdirectory the object is found in.
+ non_pic_object="$xdir$non_pic_object"
+
+ # A standard non-PIC object
+ non_pic_objects="$non_pic_objects $non_pic_object"
+ if test -z "$pic_object" || test "$pic_object" = none ; then
+ arg="$non_pic_object"
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ # Only an error if not doing a dry-run.
+ if test -z "$run"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$arg' is not a valid libtool object" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ else
+ # Dry-run case.
+
+ # Extract subdirectory from the argument.
+ xdir=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$xdir" = "X$arg"; then
+ xdir=
+ else
+ xdir="$xdir/"
+ fi
+
+ pic_object=`$echo "X${xdir}${objdir}/${arg}" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+ non_pic_object=`$echo "X${xdir}${arg}" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+ libobjs="$libobjs $pic_object"
+ non_pic_objects="$non_pic_objects $non_pic_object"
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ *.$libext)
+ # An archive.
+ deplibs="$deplibs $arg"
+ old_deplibs="$old_deplibs $arg"
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ *.la)
+ # A libtool-controlled library.
+
+ if test "$prev" = dlfiles; then
+ # This library was specified with -dlopen.
+ dlfiles="$dlfiles $arg"
+ prev=
+ elif test "$prev" = dlprefiles; then
+ # The library was specified with -dlpreopen.
+ dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $arg"
+ prev=
+ else
+ deplibs="$deplibs $arg"
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+
+ # Some other compiler argument.
+ *)
+ # Unknown arguments in both finalize_command and compile_command need
+ # to be aesthetically quoted because they are evaled later.
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*|"")
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac # arg
+
+ # Now actually substitute the argument into the commands.
+ if test -n "$arg"; then
+ compile_command="$compile_command $arg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $arg"
+ fi
+ done # argument parsing loop
+
+ if test -n "$prev"; then
+ $echo "$modename: the \`$prevarg' option requires an argument" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test "$export_dynamic" = yes && test -n "$export_dynamic_flag_spec"; then
+ eval arg=\"$export_dynamic_flag_spec\"
+ compile_command="$compile_command $arg"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $arg"
+ fi
+
+ oldlibs=
+ # calculate the name of the file, without its directory
+ outputname=`$echo "X$output" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ libobjs_save="$libobjs"
+
+ if test -n "$shlibpath_var"; then
+ # get the directories listed in $shlibpath_var
+ eval shlib_search_path=\`\$echo \"X\${$shlibpath_var}\" \| \$Xsed -e \'s/:/ /g\'\`
+ else
+ shlib_search_path=
+ fi
+ eval sys_lib_search_path=\"$sys_lib_search_path_spec\"
+ eval sys_lib_dlsearch_path=\"$sys_lib_dlsearch_path_spec\"
+
+ output_objdir=`$echo "X$output" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$output_objdir" = "X$output"; then
+ output_objdir="$objdir"
+ else
+ output_objdir="$output_objdir/$objdir"
+ fi
+ # Create the object directory.
+ if test ! -d "$output_objdir"; then
+ $show "$mkdir $output_objdir"
+ $run $mkdir $output_objdir
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$output_objdir"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Determine the type of output
+ case $output in
+ "")
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify an output file" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ *.$libext) linkmode=oldlib ;;
+ *.lo | *.$objext) linkmode=obj ;;
+ *.la) linkmode=lib ;;
+ *) linkmode=prog ;; # Anything else should be a program.
+ esac
+
+ case $host in
+ *cygwin* | *mingw* | *pw32*)
+ # don't eliminate duplications in $postdeps and $predeps
+ duplicate_compiler_generated_deps=yes
+ ;;
+ *)
+ duplicate_compiler_generated_deps=$duplicate_deps
+ ;;
+ esac
+ specialdeplibs=
+
+ libs=
+ # Find all interdependent deplibs by searching for libraries
+ # that are linked more than once (e.g. -la -lb -la)
+ for deplib in $deplibs; do
+ if test "X$duplicate_deps" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case "$libs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) specialdeplibs="$specialdeplibs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ libs="$libs $deplib"
+ done
+
+ if test "$linkmode" = lib; then
+ libs="$predeps $libs $compiler_lib_search_path $postdeps"
+
+ # Compute libraries that are listed more than once in $predeps
+ # $postdeps and mark them as special (i.e., whose duplicates are
+ # not to be eliminated).
+ pre_post_deps=
+ if test "X$duplicate_compiler_generated_deps" = "Xyes" ; then
+ for pre_post_dep in $predeps $postdeps; do
+ case "$pre_post_deps " in
+ *" $pre_post_dep "*) specialdeplibs="$specialdeplibs $pre_post_deps" ;;
+ esac
+ pre_post_deps="$pre_post_deps $pre_post_dep"
+ done
+ fi
+ pre_post_deps=
+ fi
+
+ deplibs=
+ newdependency_libs=
+ newlib_search_path=
+ need_relink=no # whether we're linking any uninstalled libtool libraries
+ notinst_deplibs= # not-installed libtool libraries
+ notinst_path= # paths that contain not-installed libtool libraries
+ case $linkmode in
+ lib)
+ passes="conv link"
+ for file in $dlfiles $dlprefiles; do
+ case $file in
+ *.la) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: libraries can \`-dlopen' only libtool libraries: $file" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ ;;
+ prog)
+ compile_deplibs=
+ finalize_deplibs=
+ alldeplibs=no
+ newdlfiles=
+ newdlprefiles=
+ passes="conv scan dlopen dlpreopen link"
+ ;;
+ *) passes="conv"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ for pass in $passes; do
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" = "lib,link" ||
+ test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,scan"; then
+ libs="$deplibs"
+ deplibs=
+ fi
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ case $pass in
+ dlopen) libs="$dlfiles" ;;
+ dlpreopen) libs="$dlprefiles" ;;
+ link)
+ libs="$deplibs %DEPLIBS%"
+ test "X$link_all_deplibs" != Xno && libs="$libs $dependency_libs"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if test "$pass" = dlopen; then
+ # Collect dlpreopened libraries
+ save_deplibs="$deplibs"
+ deplibs=
+ fi
+ for deplib in $libs; do
+ lib=
+ found=no
+ case $deplib in
+ -mt|-mthreads|-kthread|-Kthread|-pthread|-pthreads|--thread-safe)
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,link"; then
+ compile_deplibs="$deplib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$deplib $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+ -l*)
+ if test "$linkmode" != lib && test "$linkmode" != prog; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-l' is ignored for archives/objects" 1>&2
+ continue
+ fi
+ name=`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's/^-l//'`
+ for searchdir in $newlib_search_path $lib_search_path $sys_lib_search_path $shlib_search_path; do
+ for search_ext in .la $std_shrext .so .a; do
+ # Search the libtool library
+ lib="$searchdir/lib${name}${search_ext}"
+ if test -f "$lib"; then
+ if test "$search_ext" = ".la"; then
+ found=yes
+ else
+ found=no
+ fi
+ break 2
+ fi
+ done
+ done
+ if test "$found" != yes; then
+ # deplib doesn't seem to be a libtool library
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,link"; then
+ compile_deplibs="$deplib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$deplib $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ test "$linkmode" = lib && newdependency_libs="$deplib $newdependency_libs"
+ fi
+ continue
+ else # deplib is a libtool library
+ # If $allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes && $deplib is a stdlib,
+ # We need to do some special things here, and not later.
+ if test "X$allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case " $predeps $postdeps " in
+ *" $deplib "*)
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $lib |
+ grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ library_names=
+ old_library=
+ case $lib in
+ */* | *\\*) . $lib ;;
+ *) . ./$lib ;;
+ esac
+ for l in $old_library $library_names; do
+ ll="$l"
+ done
+ if test "X$ll" = "X$old_library" ; then # only static version available
+ found=no
+ ladir=`$echo "X$lib" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ test "X$ladir" = "X$lib" && ladir="."
+ lib=$ladir/$old_library
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,link"; then
+ compile_deplibs="$deplib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$deplib $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ test "$linkmode" = lib && newdependency_libs="$deplib $newdependency_libs"
+ fi
+ continue
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+ *) ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;; # -l
+ -L*)
+ case $linkmode in
+ lib)
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ test "$pass" = conv && continue
+ newdependency_libs="$deplib $newdependency_libs"
+ newlib_search_path="$newlib_search_path "`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's/^-L//'`
+ ;;
+ prog)
+ if test "$pass" = conv; then
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ continue
+ fi
+ if test "$pass" = scan; then
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ else
+ compile_deplibs="$deplib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$deplib $finalize_deplibs"
+ fi
+ newlib_search_path="$newlib_search_path "`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's/^-L//'`
+ ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-L' is ignored for archives/objects" 1>&2
+ ;;
+ esac # linkmode
+ continue
+ ;; # -L
+ -R*)
+ if test "$pass" = link; then
+ dir=`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's/^-R//'`
+ # Make sure the xrpath contains only unique directories.
+ case "$xrpath " in
+ *" $dir "*) ;;
+ *) xrpath="$xrpath $dir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ continue
+ ;;
+ *.la) lib="$deplib" ;;
+ *.$libext)
+ if test "$pass" = conv; then
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ continue
+ fi
+ case $linkmode in
+ lib)
+ if test "$deplibs_check_method" != pass_all; then
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: Trying to link with static lib archive $deplib."
+ $echo "*** I have the capability to make that library automatically link in when"
+ $echo "*** you link to this library. But I can only do this if you have a"
+ $echo "*** shared version of the library, which you do not appear to have"
+ $echo "*** because the file extensions .$libext of this argument makes me believe"
+ $echo "*** that it is just a static archive that I should not used here."
+ else
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: Linking the shared library $output against the"
+ $echo "*** static library $deplib is not portable!"
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+ prog)
+ if test "$pass" != link; then
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ else
+ compile_deplibs="$deplib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$deplib $finalize_deplibs"
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac # linkmode
+ ;; # *.$libext
+ *.lo | *.$objext)
+ if test "$pass" = conv; then
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ elif test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ if test "$pass" = dlpreopen || test "$dlopen_support" != yes || test "$build_libtool_libs" = no; then
+ # If there is no dlopen support or we're linking statically,
+ # we need to preload.
+ newdlprefiles="$newdlprefiles $deplib"
+ compile_deplibs="$deplib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$deplib $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ newdlfiles="$newdlfiles $deplib"
+ fi
+ fi
+ continue
+ ;;
+ %DEPLIBS%)
+ alldeplibs=yes
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac # case $deplib
+ if test "$found" = yes || test -f "$lib"; then :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: cannot find the library \`$lib'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Check to see that this really is a libtool archive.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $lib | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: \`$lib' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ ladir=`$echo "X$lib" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ test "X$ladir" = "X$lib" && ladir="."
+
+ dlname=
+ dlopen=
+ dlpreopen=
+ libdir=
+ library_names=
+ old_library=
+ # If the library was installed with an old release of libtool,
+ # it will not redefine variables installed, or shouldnotlink
+ installed=yes
+ shouldnotlink=no
+
+ # Read the .la file
+ case $lib in
+ */* | *\\*) . $lib ;;
+ *) . ./$lib ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" = "lib,link" ||
+ test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,scan" ||
+ { test "$linkmode" != prog && test "$linkmode" != lib; }; then
+ test -n "$dlopen" && dlfiles="$dlfiles $dlopen"
+ test -n "$dlpreopen" && dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $dlpreopen"
+ fi
+
+ if test "$pass" = conv; then
+ # Only check for convenience libraries
+ deplibs="$lib $deplibs"
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ if test -z "$old_library"; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot find name of link library for \`$lib'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ # It is a libtool convenience library, so add in its objects.
+ convenience="$convenience $ladir/$objdir/$old_library"
+ old_convenience="$old_convenience $ladir/$objdir/$old_library"
+ tmp_libs=
+ for deplib in $dependency_libs; do
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ if test "X$duplicate_deps" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case "$tmp_libs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) specialdeplibs="$specialdeplibs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ tmp_libs="$tmp_libs $deplib"
+ done
+ elif test "$linkmode" != prog && test "$linkmode" != lib; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$lib' is not a convenience library" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ continue
+ fi # $pass = conv
+
+
+ # Get the name of the library we link against.
+ linklib=
+ for l in $old_library $library_names; do
+ linklib="$l"
+ done
+ if test -z "$linklib"; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot find name of link library for \`$lib'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # This library was specified with -dlopen.
+ if test "$pass" = dlopen; then
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot -dlopen a convenience library: \`$lib'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ if test -z "$dlname" ||
+ test "$dlopen_support" != yes ||
+ test "$build_libtool_libs" = no; then
+ # If there is no dlname, no dlopen support or we're linking
+ # statically, we need to preload. We also need to preload any
+ # dependent libraries so libltdl's deplib preloader doesn't
+ # bomb out in the load deplibs phase.
+ dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $lib $dependency_libs"
+ else
+ newdlfiles="$newdlfiles $lib"
+ fi
+ continue
+ fi # $pass = dlopen
+
+ # We need an absolute path.
+ case $ladir in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) abs_ladir="$ladir" ;;
+ *)
+ abs_ladir=`cd "$ladir" && pwd`
+ if test -z "$abs_ladir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: cannot determine absolute directory name of \`$ladir'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: passing it literally to the linker, although it might fail" 1>&2
+ abs_ladir="$ladir"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ laname=`$echo "X$lib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+
+ # Find the relevant object directory and library name.
+ if test "X$installed" = Xyes; then
+ if test ! -f "$libdir/$linklib" && test -f "$abs_ladir/$linklib"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: library \`$lib' was moved." 1>&2
+ dir="$ladir"
+ absdir="$abs_ladir"
+ libdir="$abs_ladir"
+ else
+ dir="$libdir"
+ absdir="$libdir"
+ fi
+ else
+ dir="$ladir/$objdir"
+ absdir="$abs_ladir/$objdir"
+ # Remove this search path later
+ notinst_path="$notinst_path $abs_ladir"
+ fi # $installed = yes
+ name=`$echo "X$laname" | $Xsed -e 's/\.la$//' -e 's/^lib//'`
+
+ # This library was specified with -dlpreopen.
+ if test "$pass" = dlpreopen; then
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot -dlpreopen a convenience library: \`$lib'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ # Prefer using a static library (so that no silly _DYNAMIC symbols
+ # are required to link).
+ if test -n "$old_library"; then
+ newdlprefiles="$newdlprefiles $dir/$old_library"
+ # Otherwise, use the dlname, so that lt_dlopen finds it.
+ elif test -n "$dlname"; then
+ newdlprefiles="$newdlprefiles $dir/$dlname"
+ else
+ newdlprefiles="$newdlprefiles $dir/$linklib"
+ fi
+ fi # $pass = dlpreopen
+
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ # Link the convenience library
+ if test "$linkmode" = lib; then
+ deplibs="$dir/$old_library $deplibs"
+ elif test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,link"; then
+ compile_deplibs="$dir/$old_library $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$dir/$old_library $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ deplibs="$lib $deplibs" # used for prog,scan pass
+ fi
+ continue
+ fi
+
+
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog && test "$pass" != link; then
+ newlib_search_path="$newlib_search_path $ladir"
+ deplibs="$lib $deplibs"
+
+ linkalldeplibs=no
+ if test "$link_all_deplibs" != no || test -z "$library_names" ||
+ test "$build_libtool_libs" = no; then
+ linkalldeplibs=yes
+ fi
+
+ tmp_libs=
+ for deplib in $dependency_libs; do
+ case $deplib in
+ -L*) newlib_search_path="$newlib_search_path "`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's/^-L//'`;; ### testsuite: skip nested quoting test
+ esac
+ # Need to link against all dependency_libs?
+ if test "$linkalldeplibs" = yes; then
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ else
+ # Need to hardcode shared library paths
+ # or/and link against static libraries
+ newdependency_libs="$deplib $newdependency_libs"
+ fi
+ if test "X$duplicate_deps" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case "$tmp_libs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) specialdeplibs="$specialdeplibs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ tmp_libs="$tmp_libs $deplib"
+ done # for deplib
+ continue
+ fi # $linkmode = prog...
+
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" = "prog,link"; then
+ if test -n "$library_names" &&
+ { test "$prefer_static_libs" = no || test -z "$old_library"; }; then
+ # We need to hardcode the library path
+ if test -n "$shlibpath_var"; then
+ # Make sure the rpath contains only unique directories.
+ case "$temp_rpath " in
+ *" $dir "*) ;;
+ *" $absdir "*) ;;
+ *) temp_rpath="$temp_rpath $dir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ # Hardcode the library path.
+ # Skip directories that are in the system default run-time
+ # search path.
+ case " $sys_lib_dlsearch_path " in
+ *" $absdir "*) ;;
+ *)
+ case "$compile_rpath " in
+ *" $absdir "*) ;;
+ *) compile_rpath="$compile_rpath $absdir"
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ case " $sys_lib_dlsearch_path " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *)
+ case "$finalize_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) finalize_rpath="$finalize_rpath $libdir"
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi # $linkmode,$pass = prog,link...
+
+ if test "$alldeplibs" = yes &&
+ { test "$deplibs_check_method" = pass_all ||
+ { test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes &&
+ test -n "$library_names"; }; }; then
+ # We only need to search for static libraries
+ continue
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ link_static=no # Whether the deplib will be linked statically
+ if test -n "$library_names" &&
+ { test "$prefer_static_libs" = no || test -z "$old_library"; }; then
+ if test "$installed" = no; then
+ notinst_deplibs="$notinst_deplibs $lib"
+ need_relink=yes
+ fi
+ # This is a shared library
+
+ # Warn about portability, can't link against -module's on
+ # some systems (darwin)
+ if test "$shouldnotlink" = yes && test "$pass" = link ; then
+ $echo
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ $echo "*** Warning: Linking the executable $output against the loadable module"
+ else
+ $echo "*** Warning: Linking the shared library $output against the loadable module"
+ fi
+ $echo "*** $linklib is not portable!"
+ fi
+ if test "$linkmode" = lib &&
+ test "$hardcode_into_libs" = yes; then
+ # Hardcode the library path.
+ # Skip directories that are in the system default run-time
+ # search path.
+ case " $sys_lib_dlsearch_path " in
+ *" $absdir "*) ;;
+ *)
+ case "$compile_rpath " in
+ *" $absdir "*) ;;
+ *) compile_rpath="$compile_rpath $absdir"
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ case " $sys_lib_dlsearch_path " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *)
+ case "$finalize_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) finalize_rpath="$finalize_rpath $libdir"
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$old_archive_from_expsyms_cmds"; then
+ # figure out the soname
+ set dummy $library_names
+ realname="$2"
+ shift; shift
+ libname=`eval \\$echo \"$libname_spec\"`
+ # use dlname if we got it. it's perfectly good, no?
+ if test -n "$dlname"; then
+ soname="$dlname"
+ elif test -n "$soname_spec"; then
+ # bleh windows
+ case $host in
+ *cygwin* | mingw*)
+ major=`expr $current - $age`
+ versuffix="-$major"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ eval soname=\"$soname_spec\"
+ else
+ soname="$realname"
+ fi
+
+ # Make a new name for the extract_expsyms_cmds to use
+ soroot="$soname"
+ soname=`$echo $soroot | ${SED} -e 's/^.*\///'`
+ newlib="libimp-`$echo $soname | ${SED} 's/^lib//;s/\.dll$//'`.a"
+
+ # If the library has no export list, then create one now
+ if test -f "$output_objdir/$soname-def"; then :
+ else
+ $show "extracting exported symbol list from \`$soname'"
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ cmds=$extract_expsyms_cmds
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+
+ # Create $newlib
+ if test -f "$output_objdir/$newlib"; then :; else
+ $show "generating import library for \`$soname'"
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ cmds=$old_archive_from_expsyms_cmds
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+ # make sure the library variables are pointing to the new library
+ dir=$output_objdir
+ linklib=$newlib
+ fi # test -n "$old_archive_from_expsyms_cmds"
+
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog || test "$mode" != relink; then
+ add_shlibpath=
+ add_dir=
+ add=
+ lib_linked=yes
+ case $hardcode_action in
+ immediate | unsupported)
+ if test "$hardcode_direct" = no; then
+ add="$dir/$linklib"
+ case $host in
+ *-*-sco3.2v5* ) add_dir="-L$dir" ;;
+ *-*-darwin* )
+ # if the lib is a module then we can not link against
+ # it, someone is ignoring the new warnings I added
+ if /usr/bin/file -L $add 2> /dev/null | $EGREP "bundle" >/dev/null ; then
+ $echo "** Warning, lib $linklib is a module, not a shared library"
+ if test -z "$old_library" ; then
+ $echo
+ $echo "** And there doesn't seem to be a static archive available"
+ $echo "** The link will probably fail, sorry"
+ else
+ add="$dir/$old_library"
+ fi
+ fi
+ esac
+ elif test "$hardcode_minus_L" = no; then
+ case $host in
+ *-*-sunos*) add_shlibpath="$dir" ;;
+ esac
+ add_dir="-L$dir"
+ add="-l$name"
+ elif test "$hardcode_shlibpath_var" = no; then
+ add_shlibpath="$dir"
+ add="-l$name"
+ else
+ lib_linked=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ relink)
+ if test "$hardcode_direct" = yes; then
+ add="$dir/$linklib"
+ elif test "$hardcode_minus_L" = yes; then
+ add_dir="-L$dir"
+ # Try looking first in the location we're being installed to.
+ if test -n "$inst_prefix_dir"; then
+ case "$libdir" in
+ [\\/]*)
+ add_dir="$add_dir -L$inst_prefix_dir$libdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ add="-l$name"
+ elif test "$hardcode_shlibpath_var" = yes; then
+ add_shlibpath="$dir"
+ add="-l$name"
+ else
+ lib_linked=no
+ fi
+ ;;
+ *) lib_linked=no ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test "$lib_linked" != yes; then
+ $echo "$modename: configuration error: unsupported hardcode properties"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$add_shlibpath"; then
+ case :$compile_shlibpath: in
+ *":$add_shlibpath:"*) ;;
+ *) compile_shlibpath="$compile_shlibpath$add_shlibpath:" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ test -n "$add_dir" && compile_deplibs="$add_dir $compile_deplibs"
+ test -n "$add" && compile_deplibs="$add $compile_deplibs"
+ else
+ test -n "$add_dir" && deplibs="$add_dir $deplibs"
+ test -n "$add" && deplibs="$add $deplibs"
+ if test "$hardcode_direct" != yes && \
+ test "$hardcode_minus_L" != yes && \
+ test "$hardcode_shlibpath_var" = yes; then
+ case :$finalize_shlibpath: in
+ *":$libdir:"*) ;;
+ *) finalize_shlibpath="$finalize_shlibpath$libdir:" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog || test "$mode" = relink; then
+ add_shlibpath=
+ add_dir=
+ add=
+ # Finalize command for both is simple: just hardcode it.
+ if test "$hardcode_direct" = yes; then
+ add="$libdir/$linklib"
+ elif test "$hardcode_minus_L" = yes; then
+ add_dir="-L$libdir"
+ add="-l$name"
+ elif test "$hardcode_shlibpath_var" = yes; then
+ case :$finalize_shlibpath: in
+ *":$libdir:"*) ;;
+ *) finalize_shlibpath="$finalize_shlibpath$libdir:" ;;
+ esac
+ add="-l$name"
+ elif test "$hardcode_automatic" = yes; then
+ if test -n "$inst_prefix_dir" &&
+ test -f "$inst_prefix_dir$libdir/$linklib" ; then
+ add="$inst_prefix_dir$libdir/$linklib"
+ else
+ add="$libdir/$linklib"
+ fi
+ else
+ # We cannot seem to hardcode it, guess we'll fake it.
+ add_dir="-L$libdir"
+ # Try looking first in the location we're being installed to.
+ if test -n "$inst_prefix_dir"; then
+ case "$libdir" in
+ [\\/]*)
+ add_dir="$add_dir -L$inst_prefix_dir$libdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ add="-l$name"
+ fi
+
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ test -n "$add_dir" && finalize_deplibs="$add_dir $finalize_deplibs"
+ test -n "$add" && finalize_deplibs="$add $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ test -n "$add_dir" && deplibs="$add_dir $deplibs"
+ test -n "$add" && deplibs="$add $deplibs"
+ fi
+ fi
+ elif test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ # Here we assume that one of hardcode_direct or hardcode_minus_L
+ # is not unsupported. This is valid on all known static and
+ # shared platforms.
+ if test "$hardcode_direct" != unsupported; then
+ test -n "$old_library" && linklib="$old_library"
+ compile_deplibs="$dir/$linklib $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="$dir/$linklib $finalize_deplibs"
+ else
+ compile_deplibs="-l$name -L$dir $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_deplibs="-l$name -L$dir $finalize_deplibs"
+ fi
+ elif test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ # Not a shared library
+ if test "$deplibs_check_method" != pass_all; then
+ # We're trying link a shared library against a static one
+ # but the system doesn't support it.
+
+ # Just print a warning and add the library to dependency_libs so
+ # that the program can be linked against the static library.
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: This system can not link to static lib archive $lib."
+ $echo "*** I have the capability to make that library automatically link in when"
+ $echo "*** you link to this library. But I can only do this if you have a"
+ $echo "*** shared version of the library, which you do not appear to have."
+ if test "$module" = yes; then
+ $echo "*** But as you try to build a module library, libtool will still create "
+ $echo "*** a static module, that should work as long as the dlopening application"
+ $echo "*** is linked with the -dlopen flag to resolve symbols at runtime."
+ if test -z "$global_symbol_pipe"; then
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** However, this would only work if libtool was able to extract symbol"
+ $echo "*** lists from a program, using \`nm' or equivalent, but libtool could"
+ $echo "*** not find such a program. So, this module is probably useless."
+ $echo "*** \`nm' from GNU binutils and a full rebuild may help."
+ fi
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = no; then
+ build_libtool_libs=module
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ else
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ convenience="$convenience $dir/$old_library"
+ old_convenience="$old_convenience $dir/$old_library"
+ deplibs="$dir/$old_library $deplibs"
+ link_static=yes
+ fi
+ fi # link shared/static library?
+
+ if test "$linkmode" = lib; then
+ if test -n "$dependency_libs" &&
+ { test "$hardcode_into_libs" != yes ||
+ test "$build_old_libs" = yes ||
+ test "$link_static" = yes; }; then
+ # Extract -R from dependency_libs
+ temp_deplibs=
+ for libdir in $dependency_libs; do
+ case $libdir in
+ -R*) temp_xrpath=`$echo "X$libdir" | $Xsed -e 's/^-R//'`
+ case " $xrpath " in
+ *" $temp_xrpath "*) ;;
+ *) xrpath="$xrpath $temp_xrpath";;
+ esac;;
+ *) temp_deplibs="$temp_deplibs $libdir";;
+ esac
+ done
+ dependency_libs="$temp_deplibs"
+ fi
+
+ newlib_search_path="$newlib_search_path $absdir"
+ # Link against this library
+ test "$link_static" = no && newdependency_libs="$abs_ladir/$laname $newdependency_libs"
+ # ... and its dependency_libs
+ tmp_libs=
+ for deplib in $dependency_libs; do
+ newdependency_libs="$deplib $newdependency_libs"
+ if test "X$duplicate_deps" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case "$tmp_libs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) specialdeplibs="$specialdeplibs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ tmp_libs="$tmp_libs $deplib"
+ done
+
+ if test "$link_all_deplibs" != no; then
+ # Add the search paths of all dependency libraries
+ for deplib in $dependency_libs; do
+ case $deplib in
+ -L*) path="$deplib" ;;
+ *.la)
+ dir=`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ test "X$dir" = "X$deplib" && dir="."
+ # We need an absolute path.
+ case $dir in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) absdir="$dir" ;;
+ *)
+ absdir=`cd "$dir" && pwd`
+ if test -z "$absdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: cannot determine absolute directory name of \`$dir'" 1>&2
+ absdir="$dir"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if grep "^installed=no" $deplib > /dev/null; then
+ path="$absdir/$objdir"
+ else
+ eval libdir=`${SED} -n -e 's/^libdir=\(.*\)$/\1/p' $deplib`
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$deplib' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ if test "$absdir" != "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`$deplib' seems to be moved" 1>&2
+ fi
+ path="$absdir"
+ fi
+ depdepl=
+ case $host in
+ *-*-darwin*)
+ # we do not want to link against static libs,
+ # but need to link against shared
+ eval deplibrary_names=`${SED} -n -e 's/^library_names=\(.*\)$/\1/p' $deplib`
+ if test -n "$deplibrary_names" ; then
+ for tmp in $deplibrary_names ; do
+ depdepl=$tmp
+ done
+ if test -f "$path/$depdepl" ; then
+ depdepl="$path/$depdepl"
+ fi
+ # do not add paths which are already there
+ case " $newlib_search_path " in
+ *" $path "*) ;;
+ *) newlib_search_path="$newlib_search_path $path";;
+ esac
+ fi
+ path=""
+ ;;
+ *)
+ path="-L$path"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ -l*)
+ case $host in
+ *-*-darwin*)
+ # Again, we only want to link against shared libraries
+ eval tmp_libs=`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e "s,^\-l,,"`
+ for tmp in $newlib_search_path ; do
+ if test -f "$tmp/lib$tmp_libs.dylib" ; then
+ eval depdepl="$tmp/lib$tmp_libs.dylib"
+ break
+ fi
+ done
+ path=""
+ ;;
+ *) continue ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ *) continue ;;
+ esac
+ case " $deplibs " in
+ *" $depdepl "*) ;;
+ *) deplibs="$depdepl $deplibs" ;;
+ esac
+ case " $deplibs " in
+ *" $path "*) ;;
+ *) deplibs="$deplibs $path" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ fi # link_all_deplibs != no
+ fi # linkmode = lib
+ done # for deplib in $libs
+ dependency_libs="$newdependency_libs"
+ if test "$pass" = dlpreopen; then
+ # Link the dlpreopened libraries before other libraries
+ for deplib in $save_deplibs; do
+ deplibs="$deplib $deplibs"
+ done
+ fi
+ if test "$pass" != dlopen; then
+ if test "$pass" != conv; then
+ # Make sure lib_search_path contains only unique directories.
+ lib_search_path=
+ for dir in $newlib_search_path; do
+ case "$lib_search_path " in
+ *" $dir "*) ;;
+ *) lib_search_path="$lib_search_path $dir" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ newlib_search_path=
+ fi
+
+ if test "$linkmode,$pass" != "prog,link"; then
+ vars="deplibs"
+ else
+ vars="compile_deplibs finalize_deplibs"
+ fi
+ for var in $vars dependency_libs; do
+ # Add libraries to $var in reverse order
+ eval tmp_libs=\"\$$var\"
+ new_libs=
+ for deplib in $tmp_libs; do
+ # FIXME: Pedantically, this is the right thing to do, so
+ # that some nasty dependency loop isn't accidentally
+ # broken:
+ #new_libs="$deplib $new_libs"
+ # Pragmatically, this seems to cause very few problems in
+ # practice:
+ case $deplib in
+ -L*) new_libs="$deplib $new_libs" ;;
+ -R*) ;;
+ *)
+ # And here is the reason: when a library appears more
+ # than once as an explicit dependence of a library, or
+ # is implicitly linked in more than once by the
+ # compiler, it is considered special, and multiple
+ # occurrences thereof are not removed. Compare this
+ # with having the same library being listed as a
+ # dependency of multiple other libraries: in this case,
+ # we know (pedantically, we assume) the library does not
+ # need to be listed more than once, so we keep only the
+ # last copy. This is not always right, but it is rare
+ # enough that we require users that really mean to play
+ # such unportable linking tricks to link the library
+ # using -Wl,-lname, so that libtool does not consider it
+ # for duplicate removal.
+ case " $specialdeplibs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) new_libs="$deplib $new_libs" ;;
+ *)
+ case " $new_libs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) ;;
+ *) new_libs="$deplib $new_libs" ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ tmp_libs=
+ for deplib in $new_libs; do
+ case $deplib in
+ -L*)
+ case " $tmp_libs " in
+ *" $deplib "*) ;;
+ *) tmp_libs="$tmp_libs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ *) tmp_libs="$tmp_libs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ eval $var=\"$tmp_libs\"
+ done # for var
+ fi
+ # Last step: remove runtime libs from dependency_libs
+ # (they stay in deplibs)
+ tmp_libs=
+ for i in $dependency_libs ; do
+ case " $predeps $postdeps $compiler_lib_search_path " in
+ *" $i "*)
+ i=""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if test -n "$i" ; then
+ tmp_libs="$tmp_libs $i"
+ fi
+ done
+ dependency_libs=$tmp_libs
+ done # for pass
+ if test "$linkmode" = prog; then
+ dlfiles="$newdlfiles"
+ dlprefiles="$newdlprefiles"
+ fi
+
+ case $linkmode in
+ oldlib)
+ if test -n "$deplibs"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-l' and \`-L' are ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$dlfiles$dlprefiles" || test "$dlself" != no; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-dlopen' is ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$rpath"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-rpath' is ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$xrpath"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-R' is ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$vinfo"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-version-info/-version-number' is ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$release"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-release' is ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" || test -n "$export_symbols_regex"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-export-symbols' is ignored for archives" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ # Now set the variables for building old libraries.
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ oldlibs="$output"
+ objs="$objs$old_deplibs"
+ ;;
+
+ lib)
+ # Make sure we only generate libraries of the form `libNAME.la'.
+ case $outputname in
+ lib*)
+ name=`$echo "X$outputname" | $Xsed -e 's/\.la$//' -e 's/^lib//'`
+ eval shared_ext=\"$shrext_cmds\"
+ eval libname=\"$libname_spec\"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if test "$module" = no; then
+ $echo "$modename: libtool library \`$output' must begin with \`lib'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ if test "$need_lib_prefix" != no; then
+ # Add the "lib" prefix for modules if required
+ name=`$echo "X$outputname" | $Xsed -e 's/\.la$//'`
+ eval shared_ext=\"$shrext_cmds\"
+ eval libname=\"$libname_spec\"
+ else
+ libname=`$echo "X$outputname" | $Xsed -e 's/\.la$//'`
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test -n "$objs"; then
+ if test "$deplibs_check_method" != pass_all; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot build libtool library \`$output' from non-libtool objects on this host:$objs" 2>&1
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ else
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: Linking the shared library $output against the non-libtool"
+ $echo "*** objects $objs is not portable!"
+ libobjs="$libobjs $objs"
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test "$dlself" != no; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-dlopen self' is ignored for libtool libraries" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ set dummy $rpath
+ if test "$#" -gt 2; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: ignoring multiple \`-rpath's for a libtool library" 1>&2
+ fi
+ install_libdir="$2"
+
+ oldlibs=
+ if test -z "$rpath"; then
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ # Building a libtool convenience library.
+ # Some compilers have problems with a `.al' extension so
+ # convenience libraries should have the same extension an
+ # archive normally would.
+ oldlibs="$output_objdir/$libname.$libext $oldlibs"
+ build_libtool_libs=convenience
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$vinfo"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-version-info/-version-number' is ignored for convenience libraries" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$release"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-release' is ignored for convenience libraries" 1>&2
+ fi
+ else
+
+ # Parse the version information argument.
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS=':'
+ set dummy $vinfo 0 0 0
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+
+ if test -n "$8"; then
+ $echo "$modename: too many parameters to \`-version-info'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # convert absolute version numbers to libtool ages
+ # this retains compatibility with .la files and attempts
+ # to make the code below a bit more comprehensible
+
+ case $vinfo_number in
+ yes)
+ number_major="$2"
+ number_minor="$3"
+ number_revision="$4"
+ #
+ # There are really only two kinds -- those that
+ # use the current revision as the major version
+ # and those that subtract age and use age as
+ # a minor version. But, then there is irix
+ # which has an extra 1 added just for fun
+ #
+ case $version_type in
+ darwin|linux|osf|windows)
+ current=`expr $number_major + $number_minor`
+ age="$number_minor"
+ revision="$number_revision"
+ ;;
+ freebsd-aout|freebsd-elf|sunos)
+ current="$number_major"
+ revision="$number_minor"
+ age="0"
+ ;;
+ irix|nonstopux)
+ current=`expr $number_major + $number_minor - 1`
+ age="$number_minor"
+ revision="$number_minor"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: unknown library version type \`$version_type'" 1>&2
+ $echo "Fatal configuration error. See the $PACKAGE docs for more information." 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ no)
+ current="$2"
+ revision="$3"
+ age="$4"
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Check that each of the things are valid numbers.
+ case $current in
+ 0|[1-9]|[1-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9][0-9][0-9]) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: CURRENT \`$current' is not a nonnegative integer" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: \`$vinfo' is not valid version information" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $revision in
+ 0|[1-9]|[1-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9][0-9][0-9]) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: REVISION \`$revision' is not a nonnegative integer" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: \`$vinfo' is not valid version information" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $age in
+ 0|[1-9]|[1-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9][0-9]|[1-9][0-9][0-9][0-9][0-9]) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: AGE \`$age' is not a nonnegative integer" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: \`$vinfo' is not valid version information" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test "$age" -gt "$current"; then
+ $echo "$modename: AGE \`$age' is greater than the current interface number \`$current'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: \`$vinfo' is not valid version information" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Calculate the version variables.
+ major=
+ versuffix=
+ verstring=
+ case $version_type in
+ none) ;;
+
+ darwin)
+ # Like Linux, but with the current version available in
+ # verstring for coding it into the library header
+ major=.`expr $current - $age`
+ versuffix="$major.$age.$revision"
+ # Darwin ld doesn't like 0 for these options...
+ minor_current=`expr $current + 1`
+ verstring="-compatibility_version $minor_current -current_version $minor_current.$revision"
+ ;;
+
+ freebsd-aout)
+ major=".$current"
+ versuffix=".$current.$revision";
+ ;;
+
+ freebsd-elf)
+ major=".$current"
+ versuffix=".$current";
+ ;;
+
+ irix | nonstopux)
+ major=`expr $current - $age + 1`
+
+ case $version_type in
+ nonstopux) verstring_prefix=nonstopux ;;
+ *) verstring_prefix=sgi ;;
+ esac
+ verstring="$verstring_prefix$major.$revision"
+
+ # Add in all the interfaces that we are compatible with.
+ loop=$revision
+ while test "$loop" -ne 0; do
+ iface=`expr $revision - $loop`
+ loop=`expr $loop - 1`
+ verstring="$verstring_prefix$major.$iface:$verstring"
+ done
+
+ # Before this point, $major must not contain `.'.
+ major=.$major
+ versuffix="$major.$revision"
+ ;;
+
+ linux)
+ major=.`expr $current - $age`
+ versuffix="$major.$age.$revision"
+ ;;
+
+ osf)
+ major=.`expr $current - $age`
+ versuffix=".$current.$age.$revision"
+ verstring="$current.$age.$revision"
+
+ # Add in all the interfaces that we are compatible with.
+ loop=$age
+ while test "$loop" -ne 0; do
+ iface=`expr $current - $loop`
+ loop=`expr $loop - 1`
+ verstring="$verstring:${iface}.0"
+ done
+
+ # Make executables depend on our current version.
+ verstring="$verstring:${current}.0"
+ ;;
+
+ sunos)
+ major=".$current"
+ versuffix=".$current.$revision"
+ ;;
+
+ windows)
+ # Use '-' rather than '.', since we only want one
+ # extension on DOS 8.3 filesystems.
+ major=`expr $current - $age`
+ versuffix="-$major"
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: unknown library version type \`$version_type'" 1>&2
+ $echo "Fatal configuration error. See the $PACKAGE docs for more information." 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Clear the version info if we defaulted, and they specified a release.
+ if test -z "$vinfo" && test -n "$release"; then
+ major=
+ case $version_type in
+ darwin)
+ # we can't check for "0.0" in archive_cmds due to quoting
+ # problems, so we reset it completely
+ verstring=
+ ;;
+ *)
+ verstring="0.0"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if test "$need_version" = no; then
+ versuffix=
+ else
+ versuffix=".0.0"
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Remove version info from name if versioning should be avoided
+ if test "$avoid_version" = yes && test "$need_version" = no; then
+ major=
+ versuffix=
+ verstring=""
+ fi
+
+ # Check to see if the archive will have undefined symbols.
+ if test "$allow_undefined" = yes; then
+ if test "$allow_undefined_flag" = unsupported; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: undefined symbols not allowed in $host shared libraries" 1>&2
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ fi
+ else
+ # Don't allow undefined symbols.
+ allow_undefined_flag="$no_undefined_flag"
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test "$mode" != relink; then
+ # Remove our outputs, but don't remove object files since they
+ # may have been created when compiling PIC objects.
+ removelist=
+ tempremovelist=`$echo "$output_objdir/*"`
+ for p in $tempremovelist; do
+ case $p in
+ *.$objext)
+ ;;
+ $output_objdir/$outputname | $output_objdir/$libname.* | $output_objdir/${libname}${release}.*)
+ if test "X$precious_files_regex" != "X"; then
+ if echo $p | $EGREP -e "$precious_files_regex" >/dev/null 2>&1
+ then
+ continue
+ fi
+ fi
+ removelist="$removelist $p"
+ ;;
+ *) ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ if test -n "$removelist"; then
+ $show "${rm}r $removelist"
+ $run ${rm}r $removelist
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Now set the variables for building old libraries.
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = yes && test "$build_libtool_libs" != convenience ; then
+ oldlibs="$oldlibs $output_objdir/$libname.$libext"
+
+ # Transform .lo files to .o files.
+ oldobjs="$objs "`$echo "X$libobjs" | $SP2NL | $Xsed -e '/\.'${libext}'$/d' -e "$lo2o" | $NL2SP`
+ fi
+
+ # Eliminate all temporary directories.
+ for path in $notinst_path; do
+ lib_search_path=`$echo "$lib_search_path " | ${SED} -e 's% $path % %g'`
+ deplibs=`$echo "$deplibs " | ${SED} -e 's% -L$path % %g'`
+ dependency_libs=`$echo "$dependency_libs " | ${SED} -e 's% -L$path % %g'`
+ done
+
+ if test -n "$xrpath"; then
+ # If the user specified any rpath flags, then add them.
+ temp_xrpath=
+ for libdir in $xrpath; do
+ temp_xrpath="$temp_xrpath -R$libdir"
+ case "$finalize_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) finalize_rpath="$finalize_rpath $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ if test "$hardcode_into_libs" != yes || test "$build_old_libs" = yes; then
+ dependency_libs="$temp_xrpath $dependency_libs"
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Make sure dlfiles contains only unique files that won't be dlpreopened
+ old_dlfiles="$dlfiles"
+ dlfiles=
+ for lib in $old_dlfiles; do
+ case " $dlprefiles $dlfiles " in
+ *" $lib "*) ;;
+ *) dlfiles="$dlfiles $lib" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ # Make sure dlprefiles contains only unique files
+ old_dlprefiles="$dlprefiles"
+ dlprefiles=
+ for lib in $old_dlprefiles; do
+ case "$dlprefiles " in
+ *" $lib "*) ;;
+ *) dlprefiles="$dlprefiles $lib" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ if test -n "$rpath"; then
+ case $host in
+ *-*-cygwin* | *-*-mingw* | *-*-pw32* | *-*-os2* | *-*-beos*)
+ # these systems don't actually have a c library (as such)!
+ ;;
+ *-*-rhapsody* | *-*-darwin1.[012])
+ # Rhapsody C library is in the System framework
+ deplibs="$deplibs -framework System"
+ ;;
+ *-*-netbsd*)
+ # Don't link with libc until the a.out ld.so is fixed.
+ ;;
+ *-*-openbsd* | *-*-freebsd*)
+ # Do not include libc due to us having libc/libc_r.
+ test "X$arg" = "X-lc" && continue
+ ;;
+ *)
+ # Add libc to deplibs on all other systems if necessary.
+ if test "$build_libtool_need_lc" = "yes"; then
+ deplibs="$deplibs -lc"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ # Transform deplibs into only deplibs that can be linked in shared.
+ name_save=$name
+ libname_save=$libname
+ release_save=$release
+ versuffix_save=$versuffix
+ major_save=$major
+ # I'm not sure if I'm treating the release correctly. I think
+ # release should show up in the -l (ie -lgmp5) so we don't want to
+ # add it in twice. Is that correct?
+ release=""
+ versuffix=""
+ major=""
+ newdeplibs=
+ droppeddeps=no
+ case $deplibs_check_method in
+ pass_all)
+ # Don't check for shared/static. Everything works.
+ # This might be a little naive. We might want to check
+ # whether the library exists or not. But this is on
+ # osf3 & osf4 and I'm not really sure... Just
+ # implementing what was already the behavior.
+ newdeplibs=$deplibs
+ ;;
+ test_compile)
+ # This code stresses the "libraries are programs" paradigm to its
+ # limits. Maybe even breaks it. We compile a program, linking it
+ # against the deplibs as a proxy for the library. Then we can check
+ # whether they linked in statically or dynamically with ldd.
+ $rm conftest.c
+ cat > conftest.c <<EOF
+ int main() { return 0; }
+EOF
+ $rm conftest
+ $LTCC -o conftest conftest.c $deplibs
+ if test "$?" -eq 0 ; then
+ ldd_output=`ldd conftest`
+ for i in $deplibs; do
+ name="`expr $i : '-l\(.*\)'`"
+ # If $name is empty we are operating on a -L argument.
+ if test "$name" != "" && test "$name" -ne "0"; then
+ if test "X$allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case " $predeps $postdeps " in
+ *" $i "*)
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $i"
+ i=""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if test -n "$i" ; then
+ libname=`eval \\$echo \"$libname_spec\"`
+ deplib_matches=`eval \\$echo \"$library_names_spec\"`
+ set dummy $deplib_matches
+ deplib_match=$2
+ if test `expr "$ldd_output" : ".*$deplib_match"` -ne 0 ; then
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $i"
+ else
+ droppeddeps=yes
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: dynamic linker does not accept needed library $i."
+ $echo "*** I have the capability to make that library automatically link in when"
+ $echo "*** you link to this library. But I can only do this if you have a"
+ $echo "*** shared version of the library, which I believe you do not have"
+ $echo "*** because a test_compile did reveal that the linker did not use it for"
+ $echo "*** its dynamic dependency list that programs get resolved with at runtime."
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $i"
+ fi
+ done
+ else
+ # Error occurred in the first compile. Let's try to salvage
+ # the situation: Compile a separate program for each library.
+ for i in $deplibs; do
+ name="`expr $i : '-l\(.*\)'`"
+ # If $name is empty we are operating on a -L argument.
+ if test "$name" != "" && test "$name" != "0"; then
+ $rm conftest
+ $LTCC -o conftest conftest.c $i
+ # Did it work?
+ if test "$?" -eq 0 ; then
+ ldd_output=`ldd conftest`
+ if test "X$allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case " $predeps $postdeps " in
+ *" $i "*)
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $i"
+ i=""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if test -n "$i" ; then
+ libname=`eval \\$echo \"$libname_spec\"`
+ deplib_matches=`eval \\$echo \"$library_names_spec\"`
+ set dummy $deplib_matches
+ deplib_match=$2
+ if test `expr "$ldd_output" : ".*$deplib_match"` -ne 0 ; then
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $i"
+ else
+ droppeddeps=yes
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: dynamic linker does not accept needed library $i."
+ $echo "*** I have the capability to make that library automatically link in when"
+ $echo "*** you link to this library. But I can only do this if you have a"
+ $echo "*** shared version of the library, which you do not appear to have"
+ $echo "*** because a test_compile did reveal that the linker did not use this one"
+ $echo "*** as a dynamic dependency that programs can get resolved with at runtime."
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ droppeddeps=yes
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning! Library $i is needed by this library but I was not able to"
+ $echo "*** make it link in! You will probably need to install it or some"
+ $echo "*** library that it depends on before this library will be fully"
+ $echo "*** functional. Installing it before continuing would be even better."
+ fi
+ else
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $i"
+ fi
+ done
+ fi
+ ;;
+ file_magic*)
+ set dummy $deplibs_check_method
+ file_magic_regex=`expr "$deplibs_check_method" : "$2 \(.*\)"`
+ for a_deplib in $deplibs; do
+ name="`expr $a_deplib : '-l\(.*\)'`"
+ # If $name is empty we are operating on a -L argument.
+ if test "$name" != "" && test "$name" != "0"; then
+ if test "X$allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case " $predeps $postdeps " in
+ *" $a_deplib "*)
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $a_deplib"
+ a_deplib=""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if test -n "$a_deplib" ; then
+ libname=`eval \\$echo \"$libname_spec\"`
+ for i in $lib_search_path $sys_lib_search_path $shlib_search_path; do
+ potential_libs=`ls $i/$libname[.-]* 2>/dev/null`
+ for potent_lib in $potential_libs; do
+ # Follow soft links.
+ if ls -lLd "$potent_lib" 2>/dev/null \
+ | grep " -> " >/dev/null; then
+ continue
+ fi
+ # The statement above tries to avoid entering an
+ # endless loop below, in case of cyclic links.
+ # We might still enter an endless loop, since a link
+ # loop can be closed while we follow links,
+ # but so what?
+ potlib="$potent_lib"
+ while test -h "$potlib" 2>/dev/null; do
+ potliblink=`ls -ld $potlib | ${SED} 's/.* -> //'`
+ case $potliblink in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) potlib="$potliblink";;
+ *) potlib=`$echo "X$potlib" | $Xsed -e 's,[^/]*$,,'`"$potliblink";;
+ esac
+ done
+ if eval $file_magic_cmd \"\$potlib\" 2>/dev/null \
+ | ${SED} 10q \
+ | $EGREP "$file_magic_regex" > /dev/null; then
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $a_deplib"
+ a_deplib=""
+ break 2
+ fi
+ done
+ done
+ fi
+ if test -n "$a_deplib" ; then
+ droppeddeps=yes
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: linker path does not have real file for library $a_deplib."
+ $echo "*** I have the capability to make that library automatically link in when"
+ $echo "*** you link to this library. But I can only do this if you have a"
+ $echo "*** shared version of the library, which you do not appear to have"
+ $echo "*** because I did check the linker path looking for a file starting"
+ if test -z "$potlib" ; then
+ $echo "*** with $libname but no candidates were found. (...for file magic test)"
+ else
+ $echo "*** with $libname and none of the candidates passed a file format test"
+ $echo "*** using a file magic. Last file checked: $potlib"
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ # Add a -L argument.
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $a_deplib"
+ fi
+ done # Gone through all deplibs.
+ ;;
+ match_pattern*)
+ set dummy $deplibs_check_method
+ match_pattern_regex=`expr "$deplibs_check_method" : "$2 \(.*\)"`
+ for a_deplib in $deplibs; do
+ name="`expr $a_deplib : '-l\(.*\)'`"
+ # If $name is empty we are operating on a -L argument.
+ if test -n "$name" && test "$name" != "0"; then
+ if test "X$allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes" = "Xyes" ; then
+ case " $predeps $postdeps " in
+ *" $a_deplib "*)
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $a_deplib"
+ a_deplib=""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if test -n "$a_deplib" ; then
+ libname=`eval \\$echo \"$libname_spec\"`
+ for i in $lib_search_path $sys_lib_search_path $shlib_search_path; do
+ potential_libs=`ls $i/$libname[.-]* 2>/dev/null`
+ for potent_lib in $potential_libs; do
+ potlib="$potent_lib" # see symlink-check above in file_magic test
+ if eval $echo \"$potent_lib\" 2>/dev/null \
+ | ${SED} 10q \
+ | $EGREP "$match_pattern_regex" > /dev/null; then
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $a_deplib"
+ a_deplib=""
+ break 2
+ fi
+ done
+ done
+ fi
+ if test -n "$a_deplib" ; then
+ droppeddeps=yes
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: linker path does not have real file for library $a_deplib."
+ $echo "*** I have the capability to make that library automatically link in when"
+ $echo "*** you link to this library. But I can only do this if you have a"
+ $echo "*** shared version of the library, which you do not appear to have"
+ $echo "*** because I did check the linker path looking for a file starting"
+ if test -z "$potlib" ; then
+ $echo "*** with $libname but no candidates were found. (...for regex pattern test)"
+ else
+ $echo "*** with $libname and none of the candidates passed a file format test"
+ $echo "*** using a regex pattern. Last file checked: $potlib"
+ fi
+ fi
+ else
+ # Add a -L argument.
+ newdeplibs="$newdeplibs $a_deplib"
+ fi
+ done # Gone through all deplibs.
+ ;;
+ none | unknown | *)
+ newdeplibs=""
+ tmp_deplibs=`$echo "X $deplibs" | $Xsed -e 's/ -lc$//' \
+ -e 's/ -[LR][^ ]*//g'`
+ if test "X$allow_libtool_libs_with_static_runtimes" = "Xyes" ; then
+ for i in $predeps $postdeps ; do
+ # can't use Xsed below, because $i might contain '/'
+ tmp_deplibs=`$echo "X $tmp_deplibs" | ${SED} -e "1s,^X,," -e "s,$i,,"`
+ done
+ fi
+ if $echo "X $tmp_deplibs" | $Xsed -e 's/[ ]//g' \
+ | grep . >/dev/null; then
+ $echo
+ if test "X$deplibs_check_method" = "Xnone"; then
+ $echo "*** Warning: inter-library dependencies are not supported in this platform."
+ else
+ $echo "*** Warning: inter-library dependencies are not known to be supported."
+ fi
+ $echo "*** All declared inter-library dependencies are being dropped."
+ droppeddeps=yes
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ versuffix=$versuffix_save
+ major=$major_save
+ release=$release_save
+ libname=$libname_save
+ name=$name_save
+
+ case $host in
+ *-*-rhapsody* | *-*-darwin1.[012])
+ # On Rhapsody replace the C library is the System framework
+ newdeplibs=`$echo "X $newdeplibs" | $Xsed -e 's/ -lc / -framework System /'`
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test "$droppeddeps" = yes; then
+ if test "$module" = yes; then
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Warning: libtool could not satisfy all declared inter-library"
+ $echo "*** dependencies of module $libname. Therefore, libtool will create"
+ $echo "*** a static module, that should work as long as the dlopening"
+ $echo "*** application is linked with the -dlopen flag."
+ if test -z "$global_symbol_pipe"; then
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** However, this would only work if libtool was able to extract symbol"
+ $echo "*** lists from a program, using \`nm' or equivalent, but libtool could"
+ $echo "*** not find such a program. So, this module is probably useless."
+ $echo "*** \`nm' from GNU binutils and a full rebuild may help."
+ fi
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = no; then
+ oldlibs="$output_objdir/$libname.$libext"
+ build_libtool_libs=module
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ else
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ fi
+ else
+ $echo "*** The inter-library dependencies that have been dropped here will be"
+ $echo "*** automatically added whenever a program is linked with this library"
+ $echo "*** or is declared to -dlopen it."
+
+ if test "$allow_undefined" = no; then
+ $echo
+ $echo "*** Since this library must not contain undefined symbols,"
+ $echo "*** because either the platform does not support them or"
+ $echo "*** it was explicitly requested with -no-undefined,"
+ $echo "*** libtool will only create a static version of it."
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = no; then
+ oldlibs="$output_objdir/$libname.$libext"
+ build_libtool_libs=module
+ build_old_libs=yes
+ else
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+ # Done checking deplibs!
+ deplibs=$newdeplibs
+ fi
+
+ # All the library-specific variables (install_libdir is set above).
+ library_names=
+ old_library=
+ dlname=
+
+ # Test again, we may have decided not to build it any more
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ if test "$hardcode_into_libs" = yes; then
+ # Hardcode the library paths
+ hardcode_libdirs=
+ dep_rpath=
+ rpath="$finalize_rpath"
+ test "$mode" != relink && rpath="$compile_rpath$rpath"
+ for libdir in $rpath; do
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"; then
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator"; then
+ if test -z "$hardcode_libdirs"; then
+ hardcode_libdirs="$libdir"
+ else
+ # Just accumulate the unique libdirs.
+ case $hardcode_libdir_separator$hardcode_libdirs$hardcode_libdir_separator in
+ *"$hardcode_libdir_separator$libdir$hardcode_libdir_separator"*)
+ ;;
+ *)
+ hardcode_libdirs="$hardcode_libdirs$hardcode_libdir_separator$libdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ else
+ eval flag=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+ dep_rpath="$dep_rpath $flag"
+ fi
+ elif test -n "$runpath_var"; then
+ case "$perm_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) perm_rpath="$perm_rpath $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ done
+ # Substitute the hardcoded libdirs into the rpath.
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator" &&
+ test -n "$hardcode_libdirs"; then
+ libdir="$hardcode_libdirs"
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec_ld"; then
+ eval dep_rpath=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec_ld\"
+ else
+ eval dep_rpath=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+ fi
+ fi
+ if test -n "$runpath_var" && test -n "$perm_rpath"; then
+ # We should set the runpath_var.
+ rpath=
+ for dir in $perm_rpath; do
+ rpath="$rpath$dir:"
+ done
+ eval "$runpath_var='$rpath\$$runpath_var'; export $runpath_var"
+ fi
+ test -n "$dep_rpath" && deplibs="$dep_rpath $deplibs"
+ fi
+
+ shlibpath="$finalize_shlibpath"
+ test "$mode" != relink && shlibpath="$compile_shlibpath$shlibpath"
+ if test -n "$shlibpath"; then
+ eval "$shlibpath_var='$shlibpath\$$shlibpath_var'; export $shlibpath_var"
+ fi
+
+ # Get the real and link names of the library.
+ eval shared_ext=\"$shrext_cmds\"
+ eval library_names=\"$library_names_spec\"
+ set dummy $library_names
+ realname="$2"
+ shift; shift
+
+ if test -n "$soname_spec"; then
+ eval soname=\"$soname_spec\"
+ else
+ soname="$realname"
+ fi
+ if test -z "$dlname"; then
+ dlname=$soname
+ fi
+
+ lib="$output_objdir/$realname"
+ for link
+ do
+ linknames="$linknames $link"
+ done
+
+ # Use standard objects if they are pic
+ test -z "$pic_flag" && libobjs=`$echo "X$libobjs" | $SP2NL | $Xsed -e "$lo2o" | $NL2SP`
+
+ # Prepare the list of exported symbols
+ if test -z "$export_symbols"; then
+ if test "$always_export_symbols" = yes || test -n "$export_symbols_regex"; then
+ $show "generating symbol list for \`$libname.la'"
+ export_symbols="$output_objdir/$libname.exp"
+ $run $rm $export_symbols
+ cmds=$export_symbols_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ if len=`expr "X$cmd" : ".*"` &&
+ test "$len" -le "$max_cmd_len" || test "$max_cmd_len" -le -1; then
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ skipped_export=false
+ else
+ # The command line is too long to execute in one step.
+ $show "using reloadable object file for export list..."
+ skipped_export=:
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ if test -n "$export_symbols_regex"; then
+ $show "$EGREP -e \"$export_symbols_regex\" \"$export_symbols\" > \"${export_symbols}T\""
+ $run eval '$EGREP -e "$export_symbols_regex" "$export_symbols" > "${export_symbols}T"'
+ $show "$mv \"${export_symbols}T\" \"$export_symbols\""
+ $run eval '$mv "${export_symbols}T" "$export_symbols"'
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" && test -n "$include_expsyms"; then
+ $run eval '$echo "X$include_expsyms" | $SP2NL >> "$export_symbols"'
+ fi
+
+ tmp_deplibs=
+ for test_deplib in $deplibs; do
+ case " $convenience " in
+ *" $test_deplib "*) ;;
+ *)
+ tmp_deplibs="$tmp_deplibs $test_deplib"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ deplibs="$tmp_deplibs"
+
+ if test -n "$convenience"; then
+ if test -n "$whole_archive_flag_spec"; then
+ save_libobjs=$libobjs
+ eval libobjs=\"\$libobjs $whole_archive_flag_spec\"
+ else
+ gentop="$output_objdir/${outputname}x"
+ $show "${rm}r $gentop"
+ $run ${rm}r "$gentop"
+ $show "$mkdir $gentop"
+ $run $mkdir "$gentop"
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$gentop"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ generated="$generated $gentop"
+
+ for xlib in $convenience; do
+ # Extract the objects.
+ case $xlib in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) xabs="$xlib" ;;
+ *) xabs=`pwd`"/$xlib" ;;
+ esac
+ xlib=`$echo "X$xlib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ xdir="$gentop/$xlib"
+
+ $show "${rm}r $xdir"
+ $run ${rm}r "$xdir"
+ $show "$mkdir $xdir"
+ $run $mkdir "$xdir"
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$xdir"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ # We will extract separately just the conflicting names and we will no
+ # longer touch any unique names. It is faster to leave these extract
+ # automatically by $AR in one run.
+ $show "(cd $xdir && $AR x $xabs)"
+ $run eval "(cd \$xdir && $AR x \$xabs)" || exit $?
+ if ($AR t "$xabs" | sort | sort -uc >/dev/null 2>&1); then
+ :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: warning: object name conflicts; renaming object files" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: warning: to ensure that they will not overwrite" 1>&2
+ $AR t "$xabs" | sort | uniq -cd | while read -r count name
+ do
+ i=1
+ while test "$i" -le "$count"
+ do
+ # Put our $i before any first dot (extension)
+ # Never overwrite any file
+ name_to="$name"
+ while test "X$name_to" = "X$name" || test -f "$xdir/$name_to"
+ do
+ name_to=`$echo "X$name_to" | $Xsed -e "s/\([^.]*\)/\1-$i/"`
+ done
+ $show "(cd $xdir && $AR xN $i $xabs '$name' && $mv '$name' '$name_to')"
+ $run eval "(cd \$xdir && $AR xN $i \$xabs '$name' && $mv '$name' '$name_to')" || exit $?
+ i=`expr $i + 1`
+ done
+ done
+ fi
+
+ libobjs="$libobjs "`find $xdir -name \*.$objext -print -o -name \*.lo -print | $NL2SP`
+ done
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test "$thread_safe" = yes && test -n "$thread_safe_flag_spec"; then
+ eval flag=\"$thread_safe_flag_spec\"
+ linker_flags="$linker_flags $flag"
+ fi
+
+ # Make a backup of the uninstalled library when relinking
+ if test "$mode" = relink; then
+ $run eval '(cd $output_objdir && $rm ${realname}U && $mv $realname ${realname}U)' || exit $?
+ fi
+
+ # Do each of the archive commands.
+ if test "$module" = yes && test -n "$module_cmds" ; then
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" && test -n "$module_expsym_cmds"; then
+ eval test_cmds=\"$module_expsym_cmds\"
+ cmds=$module_expsym_cmds
+ else
+ eval test_cmds=\"$module_cmds\"
+ cmds=$module_cmds
+ fi
+ else
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" && test -n "$archive_expsym_cmds"; then
+ eval test_cmds=\"$archive_expsym_cmds\"
+ cmds=$archive_expsym_cmds
+ else
+ eval test_cmds=\"$archive_cmds\"
+ cmds=$archive_cmds
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test "X$skipped_export" != "X:" && len=`expr "X$test_cmds" : ".*"` &&
+ test "$len" -le "$max_cmd_len" || test "$max_cmd_len" -le -1; then
+ :
+ else
+ # The command line is too long to link in one step, link piecewise.
+ $echo "creating reloadable object files..."
+
+ # Save the value of $output and $libobjs because we want to
+ # use them later. If we have whole_archive_flag_spec, we
+ # want to use save_libobjs as it was before
+ # whole_archive_flag_spec was expanded, because we can't
+ # assume the linker understands whole_archive_flag_spec.
+ # This may have to be revisited, in case too many
+ # convenience libraries get linked in and end up exceeding
+ # the spec.
+ if test -z "$convenience" || test -z "$whole_archive_flag_spec"; then
+ save_libobjs=$libobjs
+ fi
+ save_output=$output
+
+ # Clear the reloadable object creation command queue and
+ # initialize k to one.
+ test_cmds=
+ concat_cmds=
+ objlist=
+ delfiles=
+ last_robj=
+ k=1
+ output=$output_objdir/$save_output-${k}.$objext
+ # Loop over the list of objects to be linked.
+ for obj in $save_libobjs
+ do
+ eval test_cmds=\"$reload_cmds $objlist $last_robj\"
+ if test "X$objlist" = X ||
+ { len=`expr "X$test_cmds" : ".*"` &&
+ test "$len" -le "$max_cmd_len"; }; then
+ objlist="$objlist $obj"
+ else
+ # The command $test_cmds is almost too long, add a
+ # command to the queue.
+ if test "$k" -eq 1 ; then
+ # The first file doesn't have a previous command to add.
+ eval concat_cmds=\"$reload_cmds $objlist $last_robj\"
+ else
+ # All subsequent reloadable object files will link in
+ # the last one created.
+ eval concat_cmds=\"\$concat_cmds~$reload_cmds $objlist $last_robj\"
+ fi
+ last_robj=$output_objdir/$save_output-${k}.$objext
+ k=`expr $k + 1`
+ output=$output_objdir/$save_output-${k}.$objext
+ objlist=$obj
+ len=1
+ fi
+ done
+ # Handle the remaining objects by creating one last
+ # reloadable object file. All subsequent reloadable object
+ # files will link in the last one created.
+ test -z "$concat_cmds" || concat_cmds=$concat_cmds~
+ eval concat_cmds=\"\${concat_cmds}$reload_cmds $objlist $last_robj\"
+
+ if ${skipped_export-false}; then
+ $show "generating symbol list for \`$libname.la'"
+ export_symbols="$output_objdir/$libname.exp"
+ $run $rm $export_symbols
+ libobjs=$output
+ # Append the command to create the export file.
+ eval concat_cmds=\"\$concat_cmds~$export_symbols_cmds\"
+ fi
+
+ # Set up a command to remove the reloadale object files
+ # after they are used.
+ i=0
+ while test "$i" -lt "$k"
+ do
+ i=`expr $i + 1`
+ delfiles="$delfiles $output_objdir/$save_output-${i}.$objext"
+ done
+
+ $echo "creating a temporary reloadable object file: $output"
+
+ # Loop through the commands generated above and execute them.
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $concat_cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+
+ libobjs=$output
+ # Restore the value of output.
+ output=$save_output
+
+ if test -n "$convenience" && test -n "$whole_archive_flag_spec"; then
+ eval libobjs=\"\$libobjs $whole_archive_flag_spec\"
+ fi
+ # Expand the library linking commands again to reset the
+ # value of $libobjs for piecewise linking.
+
+ # Do each of the archive commands.
+ if test "$module" = yes && test -n "$module_cmds" ; then
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" && test -n "$module_expsym_cmds"; then
+ cmds=$module_expsym_cmds
+ else
+ cmds=$module_cmds
+ fi
+ else
+ if test -n "$export_symbols" && test -n "$archive_expsym_cmds"; then
+ cmds=$archive_expsym_cmds
+ else
+ cmds=$archive_cmds
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Append the command to remove the reloadable object files
+ # to the just-reset $cmds.
+ eval cmds=\"\$cmds~\$rm $delfiles\"
+ fi
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+
+ # Restore the uninstalled library and exit
+ if test "$mode" = relink; then
+ $run eval '(cd $output_objdir && $rm ${realname}T && $mv $realname ${realname}T && $mv "$realname"U $realname)' || exit $?
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ fi
+
+ # Create links to the real library.
+ for linkname in $linknames; do
+ if test "$realname" != "$linkname"; then
+ $show "(cd $output_objdir && $rm $linkname && $LN_S $realname $linkname)"
+ $run eval '(cd $output_objdir && $rm $linkname && $LN_S $realname $linkname)' || exit $?
+ fi
+ done
+
+ # If -module or -export-dynamic was specified, set the dlname.
+ if test "$module" = yes || test "$export_dynamic" = yes; then
+ # On all known operating systems, these are identical.
+ dlname="$soname"
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ obj)
+ if test -n "$deplibs"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-l' and \`-L' are ignored for objects" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$dlfiles$dlprefiles" || test "$dlself" != no; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-dlopen' is ignored for objects" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$rpath"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-rpath' is ignored for objects" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$xrpath"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-R' is ignored for objects" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$vinfo"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-version-info' is ignored for objects" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$release"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-release' is ignored for objects" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ case $output in
+ *.lo)
+ if test -n "$objs$old_deplibs"; then
+ $echo "$modename: cannot build library object \`$output' from non-libtool objects" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ libobj="$output"
+ obj=`$echo "X$output" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+ ;;
+ *)
+ libobj=
+ obj="$output"
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Delete the old objects.
+ $run $rm $obj $libobj
+
+ # Objects from convenience libraries. This assumes
+ # single-version convenience libraries. Whenever we create
+ # different ones for PIC/non-PIC, this we'll have to duplicate
+ # the extraction.
+ reload_conv_objs=
+ gentop=
+ # reload_cmds runs $LD directly, so let us get rid of
+ # -Wl from whole_archive_flag_spec
+ wl=
+
+ if test -n "$convenience"; then
+ if test -n "$whole_archive_flag_spec"; then
+ eval reload_conv_objs=\"\$reload_objs $whole_archive_flag_spec\"
+ else
+ gentop="$output_objdir/${obj}x"
+ $show "${rm}r $gentop"
+ $run ${rm}r "$gentop"
+ $show "$mkdir $gentop"
+ $run $mkdir "$gentop"
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$gentop"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ generated="$generated $gentop"
+
+ for xlib in $convenience; do
+ # Extract the objects.
+ case $xlib in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) xabs="$xlib" ;;
+ *) xabs=`pwd`"/$xlib" ;;
+ esac
+ xlib=`$echo "X$xlib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ xdir="$gentop/$xlib"
+
+ $show "${rm}r $xdir"
+ $run ${rm}r "$xdir"
+ $show "$mkdir $xdir"
+ $run $mkdir "$xdir"
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$xdir"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ # We will extract separately just the conflicting names and we will no
+ # longer touch any unique names. It is faster to leave these extract
+ # automatically by $AR in one run.
+ $show "(cd $xdir && $AR x $xabs)"
+ $run eval "(cd \$xdir && $AR x \$xabs)" || exit $?
+ if ($AR t "$xabs" | sort | sort -uc >/dev/null 2>&1); then
+ :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: warning: object name conflicts; renaming object files" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: warning: to ensure that they will not overwrite" 1>&2
+ $AR t "$xabs" | sort | uniq -cd | while read -r count name
+ do
+ i=1
+ while test "$i" -le "$count"
+ do
+ # Put our $i before any first dot (extension)
+ # Never overwrite any file
+ name_to="$name"
+ while test "X$name_to" = "X$name" || test -f "$xdir/$name_to"
+ do
+ name_to=`$echo "X$name_to" | $Xsed -e "s/\([^.]*\)/\1-$i/"`
+ done
+ $show "(cd $xdir && $AR xN $i $xabs '$name' && $mv '$name' '$name_to')"
+ $run eval "(cd \$xdir && $AR xN $i \$xabs '$name' && $mv '$name' '$name_to')" || exit $?
+ i=`expr $i + 1`
+ done
+ done
+ fi
+
+ reload_conv_objs="$reload_objs "`find $xdir -name \*.$objext -print -o -name \*.lo -print | $NL2SP`
+ done
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Create the old-style object.
+ reload_objs="$objs$old_deplibs "`$echo "X$libobjs" | $SP2NL | $Xsed -e '/\.'${libext}$'/d' -e '/\.lib$/d' -e "$lo2o" | $NL2SP`" $reload_conv_objs" ### testsuite: skip nested quoting test
+
+ output="$obj"
+ cmds=$reload_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+
+ # Exit if we aren't doing a library object file.
+ if test -z "$libobj"; then
+ if test -n "$gentop"; then
+ $show "${rm}r $gentop"
+ $run ${rm}r $gentop
+ fi
+
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ fi
+
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" != yes; then
+ if test -n "$gentop"; then
+ $show "${rm}r $gentop"
+ $run ${rm}r $gentop
+ fi
+
+ # Create an invalid libtool object if no PIC, so that we don't
+ # accidentally link it into a program.
+ # $show "echo timestamp > $libobj"
+ # $run eval "echo timestamp > $libobj" || exit $?
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$pic_flag" || test "$pic_mode" != default; then
+ # Only do commands if we really have different PIC objects.
+ reload_objs="$libobjs $reload_conv_objs"
+ output="$libobj"
+ cmds=$reload_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$gentop"; then
+ $show "${rm}r $gentop"
+ $run ${rm}r $gentop
+ fi
+
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ prog)
+ case $host in
+ *cygwin*) output=`$echo $output | ${SED} -e 's,.exe$,,;s,$,.exe,'` ;;
+ esac
+ if test -n "$vinfo"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-version-info' is ignored for programs" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$release"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`-release' is ignored for programs" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test "$preload" = yes; then
+ if test "$dlopen_support" = unknown && test "$dlopen_self" = unknown &&
+ test "$dlopen_self_static" = unknown; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`AC_LIBTOOL_DLOPEN' not used. Assuming no dlopen support."
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ case $host in
+ *-*-rhapsody* | *-*-darwin1.[012])
+ # On Rhapsody replace the C library is the System framework
+ compile_deplibs=`$echo "X $compile_deplibs" | $Xsed -e 's/ -lc / -framework System /'`
+ finalize_deplibs=`$echo "X $finalize_deplibs" | $Xsed -e 's/ -lc / -framework System /'`
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ case $host in
+ *darwin*)
+ # Don't allow lazy linking, it breaks C++ global constructors
+ if test "$tagname" = CXX ; then
+ compile_command="$compile_command ${wl}-bind_at_load"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command ${wl}-bind_at_load"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ compile_command="$compile_command $compile_deplibs"
+ finalize_command="$finalize_command $finalize_deplibs"
+
+ if test -n "$rpath$xrpath"; then
+ # If the user specified any rpath flags, then add them.
+ for libdir in $rpath $xrpath; do
+ # This is the magic to use -rpath.
+ case "$finalize_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) finalize_rpath="$finalize_rpath $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ fi
+
+ # Now hardcode the library paths
+ rpath=
+ hardcode_libdirs=
+ for libdir in $compile_rpath $finalize_rpath; do
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"; then
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator"; then
+ if test -z "$hardcode_libdirs"; then
+ hardcode_libdirs="$libdir"
+ else
+ # Just accumulate the unique libdirs.
+ case $hardcode_libdir_separator$hardcode_libdirs$hardcode_libdir_separator in
+ *"$hardcode_libdir_separator$libdir$hardcode_libdir_separator"*)
+ ;;
+ *)
+ hardcode_libdirs="$hardcode_libdirs$hardcode_libdir_separator$libdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ else
+ eval flag=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+ rpath="$rpath $flag"
+ fi
+ elif test -n "$runpath_var"; then
+ case "$perm_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) perm_rpath="$perm_rpath $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ case $host in
+ *-*-cygwin* | *-*-mingw* | *-*-pw32* | *-*-os2*)
+ case :$dllsearchpath: in
+ *":$libdir:"*) ;;
+ *) dllsearchpath="$dllsearchpath:$libdir";;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ # Substitute the hardcoded libdirs into the rpath.
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator" &&
+ test -n "$hardcode_libdirs"; then
+ libdir="$hardcode_libdirs"
+ eval rpath=\" $hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+ fi
+ compile_rpath="$rpath"
+
+ rpath=
+ hardcode_libdirs=
+ for libdir in $finalize_rpath; do
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"; then
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator"; then
+ if test -z "$hardcode_libdirs"; then
+ hardcode_libdirs="$libdir"
+ else
+ # Just accumulate the unique libdirs.
+ case $hardcode_libdir_separator$hardcode_libdirs$hardcode_libdir_separator in
+ *"$hardcode_libdir_separator$libdir$hardcode_libdir_separator"*)
+ ;;
+ *)
+ hardcode_libdirs="$hardcode_libdirs$hardcode_libdir_separator$libdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ else
+ eval flag=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+ rpath="$rpath $flag"
+ fi
+ elif test -n "$runpath_var"; then
+ case "$finalize_perm_rpath " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) finalize_perm_rpath="$finalize_perm_rpath $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ done
+ # Substitute the hardcoded libdirs into the rpath.
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_separator" &&
+ test -n "$hardcode_libdirs"; then
+ libdir="$hardcode_libdirs"
+ eval rpath=\" $hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+ fi
+ finalize_rpath="$rpath"
+
+ if test -n "$libobjs" && test "$build_old_libs" = yes; then
+ # Transform all the library objects into standard objects.
+ compile_command=`$echo "X$compile_command" | $SP2NL | $Xsed -e "$lo2o" | $NL2SP`
+ finalize_command=`$echo "X$finalize_command" | $SP2NL | $Xsed -e "$lo2o" | $NL2SP`
+ fi
+
+ dlsyms=
+ if test -n "$dlfiles$dlprefiles" || test "$dlself" != no; then
+ if test -n "$NM" && test -n "$global_symbol_pipe"; then
+ dlsyms="${outputname}S.c"
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: not configured to extract global symbols from dlpreopened files" 1>&2
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$dlsyms"; then
+ case $dlsyms in
+ "") ;;
+ *.c)
+ # Discover the nlist of each of the dlfiles.
+ nlist="$output_objdir/${outputname}.nm"
+
+ $show "$rm $nlist ${nlist}S ${nlist}T"
+ $run $rm "$nlist" "${nlist}S" "${nlist}T"
+
+ # Parse the name list into a source file.
+ $show "creating $output_objdir/$dlsyms"
+
+ test -z "$run" && $echo > "$output_objdir/$dlsyms" "\
+/* $dlsyms - symbol resolution table for \`$outputname' dlsym emulation. */
+/* Generated by $PROGRAM - GNU $PACKAGE $VERSION$TIMESTAMP */
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+extern \"C\" {
+#endif
+
+/* Prevent the only kind of declaration conflicts we can make. */
+#define lt_preloaded_symbols some_other_symbol
+
+/* External symbol declarations for the compiler. */\
+"
+
+ if test "$dlself" = yes; then
+ $show "generating symbol list for \`$output'"
+
+ test -z "$run" && $echo ': @PROGRAM@ ' > "$nlist"
+
+ # Add our own program objects to the symbol list.
+ progfiles=`$echo "X$objs$old_deplibs" | $SP2NL | $Xsed -e "$lo2o" | $NL2SP`
+ for arg in $progfiles; do
+ $show "extracting global C symbols from \`$arg'"
+ $run eval "$NM $arg | $global_symbol_pipe >> '$nlist'"
+ done
+
+ if test -n "$exclude_expsyms"; then
+ $run eval '$EGREP -v " ($exclude_expsyms)$" "$nlist" > "$nlist"T'
+ $run eval '$mv "$nlist"T "$nlist"'
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$export_symbols_regex"; then
+ $run eval '$EGREP -e "$export_symbols_regex" "$nlist" > "$nlist"T'
+ $run eval '$mv "$nlist"T "$nlist"'
+ fi
+
+ # Prepare the list of exported symbols
+ if test -z "$export_symbols"; then
+ export_symbols="$output_objdir/$output.exp"
+ $run $rm $export_symbols
+ $run eval "${SED} -n -e '/^: @PROGRAM@$/d' -e 's/^.* \(.*\)$/\1/p' "'< "$nlist" > "$export_symbols"'
+ else
+ $run eval "${SED} -e 's/\([][.*^$]\)/\\\1/g' -e 's/^/ /' -e 's/$/$/'"' < "$export_symbols" > "$output_objdir/$output.exp"'
+ $run eval 'grep -f "$output_objdir/$output.exp" < "$nlist" > "$nlist"T'
+ $run eval 'mv "$nlist"T "$nlist"'
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ for arg in $dlprefiles; do
+ $show "extracting global C symbols from \`$arg'"
+ name=`$echo "$arg" | ${SED} -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ $run eval '$echo ": $name " >> "$nlist"'
+ $run eval "$NM $arg | $global_symbol_pipe >> '$nlist'"
+ done
+
+ if test -z "$run"; then
+ # Make sure we have at least an empty file.
+ test -f "$nlist" || : > "$nlist"
+
+ if test -n "$exclude_expsyms"; then
+ $EGREP -v " ($exclude_expsyms)$" "$nlist" > "$nlist"T
+ $mv "$nlist"T "$nlist"
+ fi
+
+ # Try sorting and uniquifying the output.
+ if grep -v "^: " < "$nlist" |
+ if sort -k 3 </dev/null >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ sort -k 3
+ else
+ sort +2
+ fi |
+ uniq > "$nlist"S; then
+ :
+ else
+ grep -v "^: " < "$nlist" > "$nlist"S
+ fi
+
+ if test -f "$nlist"S; then
+ eval "$global_symbol_to_cdecl"' < "$nlist"S >> "$output_objdir/$dlsyms"'
+ else
+ $echo '/* NONE */' >> "$output_objdir/$dlsyms"
+ fi
+
+ $echo >> "$output_objdir/$dlsyms" "\
+
+#undef lt_preloaded_symbols
+
+#if defined (__STDC__) && __STDC__
+# define lt_ptr void *
+#else
+# define lt_ptr char *
+# define const
+#endif
+
+/* The mapping between symbol names and symbols. */
+const struct {
+ const char *name;
+ lt_ptr address;
+}
+lt_preloaded_symbols[] =
+{\
+"
+
+ eval "$global_symbol_to_c_name_address" < "$nlist" >> "$output_objdir/$dlsyms"
+
+ $echo >> "$output_objdir/$dlsyms" "\
+ {0, (lt_ptr) 0}
+};
+
+/* This works around a problem in FreeBSD linker */
+#ifdef FREEBSD_WORKAROUND
+static const void *lt_preloaded_setup() {
+ return lt_preloaded_symbols;
+}
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __cplusplus
+}
+#endif\
+"
+ fi
+
+ pic_flag_for_symtable=
+ case $host in
+ # compiling the symbol table file with pic_flag works around
+ # a FreeBSD bug that causes programs to crash when -lm is
+ # linked before any other PIC object. But we must not use
+ # pic_flag when linking with -static. The problem exists in
+ # FreeBSD 2.2.6 and is fixed in FreeBSD 3.1.
+ *-*-freebsd2*|*-*-freebsd3.0*|*-*-freebsdelf3.0*)
+ case "$compile_command " in
+ *" -static "*) ;;
+ *) pic_flag_for_symtable=" $pic_flag -DFREEBSD_WORKAROUND";;
+ esac;;
+ *-*-hpux*)
+ case "$compile_command " in
+ *" -static "*) ;;
+ *) pic_flag_for_symtable=" $pic_flag";;
+ esac
+ esac
+
+ # Now compile the dynamic symbol file.
+ $show "(cd $output_objdir && $LTCC -c$no_builtin_flag$pic_flag_for_symtable \"$dlsyms\")"
+ $run eval '(cd $output_objdir && $LTCC -c$no_builtin_flag$pic_flag_for_symtable "$dlsyms")' || exit $?
+
+ # Clean up the generated files.
+ $show "$rm $output_objdir/$dlsyms $nlist ${nlist}S ${nlist}T"
+ $run $rm "$output_objdir/$dlsyms" "$nlist" "${nlist}S" "${nlist}T"
+
+ # Transform the symbol file into the correct name.
+ compile_command=`$echo "X$compile_command" | $Xsed -e "s%@SYMFILE@%$output_objdir/${outputname}S.${objext}%"`
+ finalize_command=`$echo "X$finalize_command" | $Xsed -e "s%@SYMFILE@%$output_objdir/${outputname}S.${objext}%"`
+ ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: unknown suffix for \`$dlsyms'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+ else
+ # We keep going just in case the user didn't refer to
+ # lt_preloaded_symbols. The linker will fail if global_symbol_pipe
+ # really was required.
+
+ # Nullify the symbol file.
+ compile_command=`$echo "X$compile_command" | $Xsed -e "s% @SYMFILE@%%"`
+ finalize_command=`$echo "X$finalize_command" | $Xsed -e "s% @SYMFILE@%%"`
+ fi
+
+ if test "$need_relink" = no || test "$build_libtool_libs" != yes; then
+ # Replace the output file specification.
+ compile_command=`$echo "X$compile_command" | $Xsed -e 's%@OUTPUT@%'"$output"'%g'`
+ link_command="$compile_command$compile_rpath"
+
+ # We have no uninstalled library dependencies, so finalize right now.
+ $show "$link_command"
+ $run eval "$link_command"
+ status=$?
+
+ # Delete the generated files.
+ if test -n "$dlsyms"; then
+ $show "$rm $output_objdir/${outputname}S.${objext}"
+ $run $rm "$output_objdir/${outputname}S.${objext}"
+ fi
+
+ exit $status
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$shlibpath_var"; then
+ # We should set the shlibpath_var
+ rpath=
+ for dir in $temp_rpath; do
+ case $dir in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*)
+ # Absolute path.
+ rpath="$rpath$dir:"
+ ;;
+ *)
+ # Relative path: add a thisdir entry.
+ rpath="$rpath\$thisdir/$dir:"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ temp_rpath="$rpath"
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$compile_shlibpath$finalize_shlibpath"; then
+ compile_command="$shlibpath_var=\"$compile_shlibpath$finalize_shlibpath\$$shlibpath_var\" $compile_command"
+ fi
+ if test -n "$finalize_shlibpath"; then
+ finalize_command="$shlibpath_var=\"$finalize_shlibpath\$$shlibpath_var\" $finalize_command"
+ fi
+
+ compile_var=
+ finalize_var=
+ if test -n "$runpath_var"; then
+ if test -n "$perm_rpath"; then
+ # We should set the runpath_var.
+ rpath=
+ for dir in $perm_rpath; do
+ rpath="$rpath$dir:"
+ done
+ compile_var="$runpath_var=\"$rpath\$$runpath_var\" "
+ fi
+ if test -n "$finalize_perm_rpath"; then
+ # We should set the runpath_var.
+ rpath=
+ for dir in $finalize_perm_rpath; do
+ rpath="$rpath$dir:"
+ done
+ finalize_var="$runpath_var=\"$rpath\$$runpath_var\" "
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ if test "$no_install" = yes; then
+ # We don't need to create a wrapper script.
+ link_command="$compile_var$compile_command$compile_rpath"
+ # Replace the output file specification.
+ link_command=`$echo "X$link_command" | $Xsed -e 's%@OUTPUT@%'"$output"'%g'`
+ # Delete the old output file.
+ $run $rm $output
+ # Link the executable and exit
+ $show "$link_command"
+ $run eval "$link_command" || exit $?
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ fi
+
+ if test "$hardcode_action" = relink; then
+ # Fast installation is not supported
+ link_command="$compile_var$compile_command$compile_rpath"
+ relink_command="$finalize_var$finalize_command$finalize_rpath"
+
+ $echo "$modename: warning: this platform does not like uninstalled shared libraries" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: \`$output' will be relinked during installation" 1>&2
+ else
+ if test "$fast_install" != no; then
+ link_command="$finalize_var$compile_command$finalize_rpath"
+ if test "$fast_install" = yes; then
+ relink_command=`$echo "X$compile_var$compile_command$compile_rpath" | $Xsed -e 's%@OUTPUT@%\$progdir/\$file%g'`
+ else
+ # fast_install is set to needless
+ relink_command=
+ fi
+ else
+ link_command="$compile_var$compile_command$compile_rpath"
+ relink_command="$finalize_var$finalize_command$finalize_rpath"
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # Replace the output file specification.
+ link_command=`$echo "X$link_command" | $Xsed -e 's%@OUTPUT@%'"$output_objdir/$outputname"'%g'`
+
+ # Delete the old output files.
+ $run $rm $output $output_objdir/$outputname $output_objdir/lt-$outputname
+
+ $show "$link_command"
+ $run eval "$link_command" || exit $?
+
+ # Now create the wrapper script.
+ $show "creating $output"
+
+ # Quote the relink command for shipping.
+ if test -n "$relink_command"; then
+ # Preserve any variables that may affect compiler behavior
+ for var in $variables_saved_for_relink; do
+ if eval test -z \"\${$var+set}\"; then
+ relink_command="{ test -z \"\${$var+set}\" || unset $var || { $var=; export $var; }; }; $relink_command"
+ elif eval var_value=\$$var; test -z "$var_value"; then
+ relink_command="$var=; export $var; $relink_command"
+ else
+ var_value=`$echo "X$var_value" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ relink_command="$var=\"$var_value\"; export $var; $relink_command"
+ fi
+ done
+ relink_command="(cd `pwd`; $relink_command)"
+ relink_command=`$echo "X$relink_command" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ fi
+
+ # Quote $echo for shipping.
+ if test "X$echo" = "X$SHELL $progpath --fallback-echo"; then
+ case $progpath in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) qecho="$SHELL $progpath --fallback-echo";;
+ *) qecho="$SHELL `pwd`/$progpath --fallback-echo";;
+ esac
+ qecho=`$echo "X$qecho" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ else
+ qecho=`$echo "X$echo" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ fi
+
+ # Only actually do things if our run command is non-null.
+ if test -z "$run"; then
+ # win32 will think the script is a binary if it has
+ # a .exe suffix, so we strip it off here.
+ case $output in
+ *.exe) output=`$echo $output|${SED} 's,.exe$,,'` ;;
+ esac
+ # test for cygwin because mv fails w/o .exe extensions
+ case $host in
+ *cygwin*)
+ exeext=.exe
+ outputname=`$echo $outputname|${SED} 's,.exe$,,'` ;;
+ *) exeext= ;;
+ esac
+ case $host in
+ *cygwin* | *mingw* )
+ cwrappersource=`$echo ${objdir}/lt-${output}.c`
+ cwrapper=`$echo ${output}.exe`
+ $rm $cwrappersource $cwrapper
+ trap "$rm $cwrappersource $cwrapper; exit $EXIT_FAILURE" 1 2 15
+
+ cat > $cwrappersource <<EOF
+
+/* $cwrappersource - temporary wrapper executable for $objdir/$outputname
+ Generated by $PROGRAM - GNU $PACKAGE $VERSION$TIMESTAMP
+
+ The $output program cannot be directly executed until all the libtool
+ libraries that it depends on are installed.
+
+ This wrapper executable should never be moved out of the build directory.
+ If it is, it will not operate correctly.
+
+ Currently, it simply execs the wrapper *script* "/bin/sh $output",
+ but could eventually absorb all of the scripts functionality and
+ exec $objdir/$outputname directly.
+*/
+EOF
+ cat >> $cwrappersource<<"EOF"
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <malloc.h>
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#include <assert.h>
+
+#if defined(PATH_MAX)
+# define LT_PATHMAX PATH_MAX
+#elif defined(MAXPATHLEN)
+# define LT_PATHMAX MAXPATHLEN
+#else
+# define LT_PATHMAX 1024
+#endif
+
+#ifndef DIR_SEPARATOR
+#define DIR_SEPARATOR '/'
+#endif
+
+#if defined (_WIN32) || defined (__MSDOS__) || defined (__DJGPP__) || \
+ defined (__OS2__)
+#define HAVE_DOS_BASED_FILE_SYSTEM
+#ifndef DIR_SEPARATOR_2
+#define DIR_SEPARATOR_2 '\\'
+#endif
+#endif
+
+#ifndef DIR_SEPARATOR_2
+# define IS_DIR_SEPARATOR(ch) ((ch) == DIR_SEPARATOR)
+#else /* DIR_SEPARATOR_2 */
+# define IS_DIR_SEPARATOR(ch) \
+ (((ch) == DIR_SEPARATOR) || ((ch) == DIR_SEPARATOR_2))
+#endif /* DIR_SEPARATOR_2 */
+
+#define XMALLOC(type, num) ((type *) xmalloc ((num) * sizeof(type)))
+#define XFREE(stale) do { \
+ if (stale) { free ((void *) stale); stale = 0; } \
+} while (0)
+
+const char *program_name = NULL;
+
+void * xmalloc (size_t num);
+char * xstrdup (const char *string);
+char * basename (const char *name);
+char * fnqualify(const char *path);
+char * strendzap(char *str, const char *pat);
+void lt_fatal (const char *message, ...);
+
+int
+main (int argc, char *argv[])
+{
+ char **newargz;
+ int i;
+
+ program_name = (char *) xstrdup ((char *) basename (argv[0]));
+ newargz = XMALLOC(char *, argc+2);
+EOF
+
+ cat >> $cwrappersource <<EOF
+ newargz[0] = "$SHELL";
+EOF
+
+ cat >> $cwrappersource <<"EOF"
+ newargz[1] = fnqualify(argv[0]);
+ /* we know the script has the same name, without the .exe */
+ /* so make sure newargz[1] doesn't end in .exe */
+ strendzap(newargz[1],".exe");
+ for (i = 1; i < argc; i++)
+ newargz[i+1] = xstrdup(argv[i]);
+ newargz[argc+1] = NULL;
+EOF
+
+ cat >> $cwrappersource <<EOF
+ execv("$SHELL",newargz);
+EOF
+
+ cat >> $cwrappersource <<"EOF"
+}
+
+void *
+xmalloc (size_t num)
+{
+ void * p = (void *) malloc (num);
+ if (!p)
+ lt_fatal ("Memory exhausted");
+
+ return p;
+}
+
+char *
+xstrdup (const char *string)
+{
+ return string ? strcpy ((char *) xmalloc (strlen (string) + 1), string) : NULL
+;
+}
+
+char *
+basename (const char *name)
+{
+ const char *base;
+
+#if defined (HAVE_DOS_BASED_FILE_SYSTEM)
+ /* Skip over the disk name in MSDOS pathnames. */
+ if (isalpha (name[0]) && name[1] == ':')
+ name += 2;
+#endif
+
+ for (base = name; *name; name++)
+ if (IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (*name))
+ base = name + 1;
+ return (char *) base;
+}
+
+char *
+fnqualify(const char *path)
+{
+ size_t size;
+ char *p;
+ char tmp[LT_PATHMAX + 1];
+
+ assert(path != NULL);
+
+ /* Is it qualified already? */
+#if defined (HAVE_DOS_BASED_FILE_SYSTEM)
+ if (isalpha (path[0]) && path[1] == ':')
+ return xstrdup (path);
+#endif
+ if (IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (path[0]))
+ return xstrdup (path);
+
+ /* prepend the current directory */
+ /* doesn't handle '~' */
+ if (getcwd (tmp, LT_PATHMAX) == NULL)
+ lt_fatal ("getcwd failed");
+ size = strlen(tmp) + 1 + strlen(path) + 1; /* +2 for '/' and '\0' */
+ p = XMALLOC(char, size);
+ sprintf(p, "%s%c%s", tmp, DIR_SEPARATOR, path);
+ return p;
+}
+
+char *
+strendzap(char *str, const char *pat)
+{
+ size_t len, patlen;
+
+ assert(str != NULL);
+ assert(pat != NULL);
+
+ len = strlen(str);
+ patlen = strlen(pat);
+
+ if (patlen <= len)
+ {
+ str += len - patlen;
+ if (strcmp(str, pat) == 0)
+ *str = '\0';
+ }
+ return str;
+}
+
+static void
+lt_error_core (int exit_status, const char * mode,
+ const char * message, va_list ap)
+{
+ fprintf (stderr, "%s: %s: ", program_name, mode);
+ vfprintf (stderr, message, ap);
+ fprintf (stderr, ".\n");
+
+ if (exit_status >= 0)
+ exit (exit_status);
+}
+
+void
+lt_fatal (const char *message, ...)
+{
+ va_list ap;
+ va_start (ap, message);
+ lt_error_core (EXIT_FAILURE, "FATAL", message, ap);
+ va_end (ap);
+}
+EOF
+ # we should really use a build-platform specific compiler
+ # here, but OTOH, the wrappers (shell script and this C one)
+ # are only useful if you want to execute the "real" binary.
+ # Since the "real" binary is built for $host, then this
+ # wrapper might as well be built for $host, too.
+ $run $LTCC -s -o $cwrapper $cwrappersource
+ ;;
+ esac
+ $rm $output
+ trap "$rm $output; exit $EXIT_FAILURE" 1 2 15
+
+ $echo > $output "\
+#! $SHELL
+
+# $output - temporary wrapper script for $objdir/$outputname
+# Generated by $PROGRAM - GNU $PACKAGE $VERSION$TIMESTAMP
+#
+# The $output program cannot be directly executed until all the libtool
+# libraries that it depends on are installed.
+#
+# This wrapper script should never be moved out of the build directory.
+# If it is, it will not operate correctly.
+
+# Sed substitution that helps us do robust quoting. It backslashifies
+# metacharacters that are still active within double-quoted strings.
+Xsed='${SED} -e 1s/^X//'
+sed_quote_subst='$sed_quote_subst'
+
+# The HP-UX ksh and POSIX shell print the target directory to stdout
+# if CDPATH is set.
+if test \"\${CDPATH+set}\" = set; then CDPATH=:; export CDPATH; fi
+
+relink_command=\"$relink_command\"
+
+# This environment variable determines our operation mode.
+if test \"\$libtool_install_magic\" = \"$magic\"; then
+ # install mode needs the following variable:
+ notinst_deplibs='$notinst_deplibs'
+else
+ # When we are sourced in execute mode, \$file and \$echo are already set.
+ if test \"\$libtool_execute_magic\" != \"$magic\"; then
+ echo=\"$qecho\"
+ file=\"\$0\"
+ # Make sure echo works.
+ if test \"X\$1\" = X--no-reexec; then
+ # Discard the --no-reexec flag, and continue.
+ shift
+ elif test \"X\`(\$echo '\t') 2>/dev/null\`\" = 'X\t'; then
+ # Yippee, \$echo works!
+ :
+ else
+ # Restart under the correct shell, and then maybe \$echo will work.
+ exec $SHELL \"\$0\" --no-reexec \${1+\"\$@\"}
+ fi
+ fi\
+"
+ $echo >> $output "\
+
+ # Find the directory that this script lives in.
+ thisdir=\`\$echo \"X\$file\" | \$Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'\`
+ test \"x\$thisdir\" = \"x\$file\" && thisdir=.
+
+ # Follow symbolic links until we get to the real thisdir.
+ file=\`ls -ld \"\$file\" | ${SED} -n 's/.*-> //p'\`
+ while test -n \"\$file\"; do
+ destdir=\`\$echo \"X\$file\" | \$Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*\$%%'\`
+
+ # If there was a directory component, then change thisdir.
+ if test \"x\$destdir\" != \"x\$file\"; then
+ case \"\$destdir\" in
+ [\\\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\\\/]*) thisdir=\"\$destdir\" ;;
+ *) thisdir=\"\$thisdir/\$destdir\" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ file=\`\$echo \"X\$file\" | \$Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'\`
+ file=\`ls -ld \"\$thisdir/\$file\" | ${SED} -n 's/.*-> //p'\`
+ done
+
+ # Try to get the absolute directory name.
+ absdir=\`cd \"\$thisdir\" && pwd\`
+ test -n \"\$absdir\" && thisdir=\"\$absdir\"
+"
+
+ if test "$fast_install" = yes; then
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ program=lt-'$outputname'$exeext
+ progdir=\"\$thisdir/$objdir\"
+
+ if test ! -f \"\$progdir/\$program\" || \\
+ { file=\`ls -1dt \"\$progdir/\$program\" \"\$progdir/../\$program\" 2>/dev/null | ${SED} 1q\`; \\
+ test \"X\$file\" != \"X\$progdir/\$program\"; }; then
+
+ file=\"\$\$-\$program\"
+
+ if test ! -d \"\$progdir\"; then
+ $mkdir \"\$progdir\"
+ else
+ $rm \"\$progdir/\$file\"
+ fi"
+
+ $echo >> $output "\
+
+ # relink executable if necessary
+ if test -n \"\$relink_command\"; then
+ if relink_command_output=\`eval \$relink_command 2>&1\`; then :
+ else
+ $echo \"\$relink_command_output\" >&2
+ $rm \"\$progdir/\$file\"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ $mv \"\$progdir/\$file\" \"\$progdir/\$program\" 2>/dev/null ||
+ { $rm \"\$progdir/\$program\";
+ $mv \"\$progdir/\$file\" \"\$progdir/\$program\"; }
+ $rm \"\$progdir/\$file\"
+ fi"
+ else
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ program='$outputname'
+ progdir=\"\$thisdir/$objdir\"
+"
+ fi
+
+ $echo >> $output "\
+
+ if test -f \"\$progdir/\$program\"; then"
+
+ # Export our shlibpath_var if we have one.
+ if test "$shlibpath_overrides_runpath" = yes && test -n "$shlibpath_var" && test -n "$temp_rpath"; then
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ # Add our own library path to $shlibpath_var
+ $shlibpath_var=\"$temp_rpath\$$shlibpath_var\"
+
+ # Some systems cannot cope with colon-terminated $shlibpath_var
+ # The second colon is a workaround for a bug in BeOS R4 sed
+ $shlibpath_var=\`\$echo \"X\$$shlibpath_var\" | \$Xsed -e 's/::*\$//'\`
+
+ export $shlibpath_var
+"
+ fi
+
+ # fixup the dll searchpath if we need to.
+ if test -n "$dllsearchpath"; then
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ # Add the dll search path components to the executable PATH
+ PATH=$dllsearchpath:\$PATH
+"
+ fi
+
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ if test \"\$libtool_execute_magic\" != \"$magic\"; then
+ # Run the actual program with our arguments.
+"
+ case $host in
+ # Backslashes separate directories on plain windows
+ *-*-mingw | *-*-os2*)
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ exec \$progdir\\\\\$program \${1+\"\$@\"}
+"
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ exec \$progdir/\$program \${1+\"\$@\"}
+"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ $echo >> $output "\
+ \$echo \"\$0: cannot exec \$program \${1+\"\$@\"}\"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ else
+ # The program doesn't exist.
+ \$echo \"\$0: error: \$progdir/\$program does not exist\" 1>&2
+ \$echo \"This script is just a wrapper for \$program.\" 1>&2
+ $echo \"See the $PACKAGE documentation for more information.\" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+fi\
+"
+ chmod +x $output
+ fi
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # See if we need to build an old-fashioned archive.
+ for oldlib in $oldlibs; do
+
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = convenience; then
+ oldobjs="$libobjs_save"
+ addlibs="$convenience"
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ else
+ if test "$build_libtool_libs" = module; then
+ oldobjs="$libobjs_save"
+ build_libtool_libs=no
+ else
+ oldobjs="$old_deplibs $non_pic_objects"
+ fi
+ addlibs="$old_convenience"
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$addlibs"; then
+ gentop="$output_objdir/${outputname}x"
+ $show "${rm}r $gentop"
+ $run ${rm}r "$gentop"
+ $show "$mkdir $gentop"
+ $run $mkdir "$gentop"
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$gentop"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ generated="$generated $gentop"
+
+ # Add in members from convenience archives.
+ for xlib in $addlibs; do
+ # Extract the objects.
+ case $xlib in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) xabs="$xlib" ;;
+ *) xabs=`pwd`"/$xlib" ;;
+ esac
+ xlib=`$echo "X$xlib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ xdir="$gentop/$xlib"
+
+ $show "${rm}r $xdir"
+ $run ${rm}r "$xdir"
+ $show "$mkdir $xdir"
+ $run $mkdir "$xdir"
+ status=$?
+ if test "$status" -ne 0 && test ! -d "$xdir"; then
+ exit $status
+ fi
+ # We will extract separately just the conflicting names and we will no
+ # longer touch any unique names. It is faster to leave these extract
+ # automatically by $AR in one run.
+ $show "(cd $xdir && $AR x $xabs)"
+ $run eval "(cd \$xdir && $AR x \$xabs)" || exit $?
+ if ($AR t "$xabs" | sort | sort -uc >/dev/null 2>&1); then
+ :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: warning: object name conflicts; renaming object files" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: warning: to ensure that they will not overwrite" 1>&2
+ $AR t "$xabs" | sort | uniq -cd | while read -r count name
+ do
+ i=1
+ while test "$i" -le "$count"
+ do
+ # Put our $i before any first dot (extension)
+ # Never overwrite any file
+ name_to="$name"
+ while test "X$name_to" = "X$name" || test -f "$xdir/$name_to"
+ do
+ name_to=`$echo "X$name_to" | $Xsed -e "s/\([^.]*\)/\1-$i/"`
+ done
+ $show "(cd $xdir && $AR xN $i $xabs '$name' && $mv '$name' '$name_to')"
+ $run eval "(cd \$xdir && $AR xN $i \$xabs '$name' && $mv '$name' '$name_to')" || exit $?
+ i=`expr $i + 1`
+ done
+ done
+ fi
+
+ oldobjs="$oldobjs "`find $xdir -name \*.${objext} -print -o -name \*.lo -print | $NL2SP`
+ done
+ fi
+
+ # Do each command in the archive commands.
+ if test -n "$old_archive_from_new_cmds" && test "$build_libtool_libs" = yes; then
+ cmds=$old_archive_from_new_cmds
+ else
+ eval cmds=\"$old_archive_cmds\"
+
+ if len=`expr "X$cmds" : ".*"` &&
+ test "$len" -le "$max_cmd_len" || test "$max_cmd_len" -le -1; then
+ cmds=$old_archive_cmds
+ else
+ # the command line is too long to link in one step, link in parts
+ $echo "using piecewise archive linking..."
+ save_RANLIB=$RANLIB
+ RANLIB=:
+ objlist=
+ concat_cmds=
+ save_oldobjs=$oldobjs
+ # GNU ar 2.10+ was changed to match POSIX; thus no paths are
+ # encoded into archives. This makes 'ar r' malfunction in
+ # this piecewise linking case whenever conflicting object
+ # names appear in distinct ar calls; check, warn and compensate.
+ if (for obj in $save_oldobjs
+ do
+ $echo "X$obj" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'
+ done | sort | sort -uc >/dev/null 2>&1); then
+ :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: warning: object name conflicts; overriding AR_FLAGS to 'cq'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$modename: warning: to ensure that POSIX-compatible ar will work" 1>&2
+ AR_FLAGS=cq
+ fi
+ # Is there a better way of finding the last object in the list?
+ for obj in $save_oldobjs
+ do
+ last_oldobj=$obj
+ done
+ for obj in $save_oldobjs
+ do
+ oldobjs="$objlist $obj"
+ objlist="$objlist $obj"
+ eval test_cmds=\"$old_archive_cmds\"
+ if len=`expr "X$test_cmds" : ".*"` &&
+ test "$len" -le "$max_cmd_len"; then
+ :
+ else
+ # the above command should be used before it gets too long
+ oldobjs=$objlist
+ if test "$obj" = "$last_oldobj" ; then
+ RANLIB=$save_RANLIB
+ fi
+ test -z "$concat_cmds" || concat_cmds=$concat_cmds~
+ eval concat_cmds=\"\${concat_cmds}$old_archive_cmds\"
+ objlist=
+ fi
+ done
+ RANLIB=$save_RANLIB
+ oldobjs=$objlist
+ if test "X$oldobjs" = "X" ; then
+ eval cmds=\"\$concat_cmds\"
+ else
+ eval cmds=\"\$concat_cmds~\$old_archive_cmds\"
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ done
+
+ if test -n "$generated"; then
+ $show "${rm}r$generated"
+ $run ${rm}r$generated
+ fi
+
+ # Now create the libtool archive.
+ case $output in
+ *.la)
+ old_library=
+ test "$build_old_libs" = yes && old_library="$libname.$libext"
+ $show "creating $output"
+
+ # Preserve any variables that may affect compiler behavior
+ for var in $variables_saved_for_relink; do
+ if eval test -z \"\${$var+set}\"; then
+ relink_command="{ test -z \"\${$var+set}\" || unset $var || { $var=; export $var; }; }; $relink_command"
+ elif eval var_value=\$$var; test -z "$var_value"; then
+ relink_command="$var=; export $var; $relink_command"
+ else
+ var_value=`$echo "X$var_value" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ relink_command="$var=\"$var_value\"; export $var; $relink_command"
+ fi
+ done
+ # Quote the link command for shipping.
+ relink_command="(cd `pwd`; $SHELL $progpath $preserve_args --mode=relink $libtool_args @inst_prefix_dir@)"
+ relink_command=`$echo "X$relink_command" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ if test "$hardcode_automatic" = yes ; then
+ relink_command=
+ fi
+
+
+ # Only create the output if not a dry run.
+ if test -z "$run"; then
+ for installed in no yes; do
+ if test "$installed" = yes; then
+ if test -z "$install_libdir"; then
+ break
+ fi
+ output="$output_objdir/$outputname"i
+ # Replace all uninstalled libtool libraries with the installed ones
+ newdependency_libs=
+ for deplib in $dependency_libs; do
+ case $deplib in
+ *.la)
+ name=`$echo "X$deplib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ eval libdir=`${SED} -n -e 's/^libdir=\(.*\)$/\1/p' $deplib`
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$deplib' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ newdependency_libs="$newdependency_libs $libdir/$name"
+ ;;
+ *) newdependency_libs="$newdependency_libs $deplib" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ dependency_libs="$newdependency_libs"
+ newdlfiles=
+ for lib in $dlfiles; do
+ name=`$echo "X$lib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ eval libdir=`${SED} -n -e 's/^libdir=\(.*\)$/\1/p' $lib`
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$lib' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ newdlfiles="$newdlfiles $libdir/$name"
+ done
+ dlfiles="$newdlfiles"
+ newdlprefiles=
+ for lib in $dlprefiles; do
+ name=`$echo "X$lib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ eval libdir=`${SED} -n -e 's/^libdir=\(.*\)$/\1/p' $lib`
+ if test -z "$libdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$lib' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ newdlprefiles="$newdlprefiles $libdir/$name"
+ done
+ dlprefiles="$newdlprefiles"
+ else
+ newdlfiles=
+ for lib in $dlfiles; do
+ case $lib in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) abs="$lib" ;;
+ *) abs=`pwd`"/$lib" ;;
+ esac
+ newdlfiles="$newdlfiles $abs"
+ done
+ dlfiles="$newdlfiles"
+ newdlprefiles=
+ for lib in $dlprefiles; do
+ case $lib in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) abs="$lib" ;;
+ *) abs=`pwd`"/$lib" ;;
+ esac
+ newdlprefiles="$newdlprefiles $abs"
+ done
+ dlprefiles="$newdlprefiles"
+ fi
+ $rm $output
+ # place dlname in correct position for cygwin
+ tdlname=$dlname
+ case $host,$output,$installed,$module,$dlname in
+ *cygwin*,*lai,yes,no,*.dll | *mingw*,*lai,yes,no,*.dll) tdlname=../bin/$dlname ;;
+ esac
+ $echo > $output "\
+# $outputname - a libtool library file
+# Generated by $PROGRAM - GNU $PACKAGE $VERSION$TIMESTAMP
+#
+# Please DO NOT delete this file!
+# It is necessary for linking the library.
+
+# The name that we can dlopen(3).
+dlname='$tdlname'
+
+# Names of this library.
+library_names='$library_names'
+
+# The name of the static archive.
+old_library='$old_library'
+
+# Libraries that this one depends upon.
+dependency_libs='$dependency_libs'
+
+# Version information for $libname.
+current=$current
+age=$age
+revision=$revision
+
+# Is this an already installed library?
+installed=$installed
+
+# Should we warn about portability when linking against -modules?
+shouldnotlink=$module
+
+# Files to dlopen/dlpreopen
+dlopen='$dlfiles'
+dlpreopen='$dlprefiles'
+
+# Directory that this library needs to be installed in:
+libdir='$install_libdir'"
+ if test "$installed" = no && test "$need_relink" = yes; then
+ $echo >> $output "\
+relink_command=\"$relink_command\""
+ fi
+ done
+ fi
+
+ # Do a symbolic link so that the libtool archive can be found in
+ # LD_LIBRARY_PATH before the program is installed.
+ $show "(cd $output_objdir && $rm $outputname && $LN_S ../$outputname $outputname)"
+ $run eval '(cd $output_objdir && $rm $outputname && $LN_S ../$outputname $outputname)' || exit $?
+ ;;
+ esac
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ # libtool install mode
+ install)
+ modename="$modename: install"
+
+ # There may be an optional sh(1) argument at the beginning of
+ # install_prog (especially on Windows NT).
+ if test "$nonopt" = "$SHELL" || test "$nonopt" = /bin/sh ||
+ # Allow the use of GNU shtool's install command.
+ $echo "X$nonopt" | $Xsed | grep shtool > /dev/null; then
+ # Aesthetically quote it.
+ arg=`$echo "X$nonopt" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*)
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ install_prog="$arg "
+ arg="$1"
+ shift
+ else
+ install_prog=
+ arg="$nonopt"
+ fi
+
+ # The real first argument should be the name of the installation program.
+ # Aesthetically quote it.
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*)
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ install_prog="$install_prog$arg"
+
+ # We need to accept at least all the BSD install flags.
+ dest=
+ files=
+ opts=
+ prev=
+ install_type=
+ isdir=no
+ stripme=
+ for arg
+ do
+ if test -n "$dest"; then
+ files="$files $dest"
+ dest="$arg"
+ continue
+ fi
+
+ case $arg in
+ -d) isdir=yes ;;
+ -f) prev="-f" ;;
+ -g) prev="-g" ;;
+ -m) prev="-m" ;;
+ -o) prev="-o" ;;
+ -s)
+ stripme=" -s"
+ continue
+ ;;
+ -*) ;;
+
+ *)
+ # If the previous option needed an argument, then skip it.
+ if test -n "$prev"; then
+ prev=
+ else
+ dest="$arg"
+ continue
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Aesthetically quote the argument.
+ arg=`$echo "X$arg" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ case $arg in
+ *[\[\~\#\^\&\*\(\)\{\}\|\;\<\>\?\'\ \ ]*|*]*)
+ arg="\"$arg\""
+ ;;
+ esac
+ install_prog="$install_prog $arg"
+ done
+
+ if test -z "$install_prog"; then
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify an install program" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$prev"; then
+ $echo "$modename: the \`$prev' option requires an argument" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test -z "$files"; then
+ if test -z "$dest"; then
+ $echo "$modename: no file or destination specified" 1>&2
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify a destination" 1>&2
+ fi
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Strip any trailing slash from the destination.
+ dest=`$echo "X$dest" | $Xsed -e 's%/$%%'`
+
+ # Check to see that the destination is a directory.
+ test -d "$dest" && isdir=yes
+ if test "$isdir" = yes; then
+ destdir="$dest"
+ destname=
+ else
+ destdir=`$echo "X$dest" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ test "X$destdir" = "X$dest" && destdir=.
+ destname=`$echo "X$dest" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+
+ # Not a directory, so check to see that there is only one file specified.
+ set dummy $files
+ if test "$#" -gt 2; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$dest' is not a directory" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ fi
+ case $destdir in
+ [\\/]* | [A-Za-z]:[\\/]*) ;;
+ *)
+ for file in $files; do
+ case $file in
+ *.lo) ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: \`$destdir' must be an absolute directory name" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # This variable tells wrapper scripts just to set variables rather
+ # than running their programs.
+ libtool_install_magic="$magic"
+
+ staticlibs=
+ future_libdirs=
+ current_libdirs=
+ for file in $files; do
+
+ # Do each installation.
+ case $file in
+ *.$libext)
+ # Do the static libraries later.
+ staticlibs="$staticlibs $file"
+ ;;
+
+ *.la)
+ # Check to see that this really is a libtool archive.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $file | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: \`$file' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ library_names=
+ old_library=
+ relink_command=
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $file in
+ */* | *\\*) . $file ;;
+ *) . ./$file ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Add the libdir to current_libdirs if it is the destination.
+ if test "X$destdir" = "X$libdir"; then
+ case "$current_libdirs " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) current_libdirs="$current_libdirs $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ else
+ # Note the libdir as a future libdir.
+ case "$future_libdirs " in
+ *" $libdir "*) ;;
+ *) future_libdirs="$future_libdirs $libdir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ dir=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`/
+ test "X$dir" = "X$file/" && dir=
+ dir="$dir$objdir"
+
+ if test -n "$relink_command"; then
+ # Determine the prefix the user has applied to our future dir.
+ inst_prefix_dir=`$echo "$destdir" | $SED "s%$libdir\$%%"`
+
+ # Don't allow the user to place us outside of our expected
+ # location b/c this prevents finding dependent libraries that
+ # are installed to the same prefix.
+ # At present, this check doesn't affect windows .dll's that
+ # are installed into $libdir/../bin (currently, that works fine)
+ # but it's something to keep an eye on.
+ if test "$inst_prefix_dir" = "$destdir"; then
+ $echo "$modename: error: cannot install \`$file' to a directory not ending in $libdir" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$inst_prefix_dir"; then
+ # Stick the inst_prefix_dir data into the link command.
+ relink_command=`$echo "$relink_command" | $SED "s%@inst_prefix_dir@%-inst-prefix-dir $inst_prefix_dir%"`
+ else
+ relink_command=`$echo "$relink_command" | $SED "s%@inst_prefix_dir@%%"`
+ fi
+
+ $echo "$modename: warning: relinking \`$file'" 1>&2
+ $show "$relink_command"
+ if $run eval "$relink_command"; then :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: error: relink \`$file' with the above command before installing it" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # See the names of the shared library.
+ set dummy $library_names
+ if test -n "$2"; then
+ realname="$2"
+ shift
+ shift
+
+ srcname="$realname"
+ test -n "$relink_command" && srcname="$realname"T
+
+ # Install the shared library and build the symlinks.
+ $show "$install_prog $dir/$srcname $destdir/$realname"
+ $run eval "$install_prog $dir/$srcname $destdir/$realname" || exit $?
+ if test -n "$stripme" && test -n "$striplib"; then
+ $show "$striplib $destdir/$realname"
+ $run eval "$striplib $destdir/$realname" || exit $?
+ fi
+
+ if test "$#" -gt 0; then
+ # Delete the old symlinks, and create new ones.
+ for linkname
+ do
+ if test "$linkname" != "$realname"; then
+ $show "(cd $destdir && $rm $linkname && $LN_S $realname $linkname)"
+ $run eval "(cd $destdir && $rm $linkname && $LN_S $realname $linkname)"
+ fi
+ done
+ fi
+
+ # Do each command in the postinstall commands.
+ lib="$destdir/$realname"
+ cmds=$postinstall_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+
+ # Install the pseudo-library for information purposes.
+ name=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ instname="$dir/$name"i
+ $show "$install_prog $instname $destdir/$name"
+ $run eval "$install_prog $instname $destdir/$name" || exit $?
+
+ # Maybe install the static library, too.
+ test -n "$old_library" && staticlibs="$staticlibs $dir/$old_library"
+ ;;
+
+ *.lo)
+ # Install (i.e. copy) a libtool object.
+
+ # Figure out destination file name, if it wasn't already specified.
+ if test -n "$destname"; then
+ destfile="$destdir/$destname"
+ else
+ destfile=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ destfile="$destdir/$destfile"
+ fi
+
+ # Deduce the name of the destination old-style object file.
+ case $destfile in
+ *.lo)
+ staticdest=`$echo "X$destfile" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+ ;;
+ *.$objext)
+ staticdest="$destfile"
+ destfile=
+ ;;
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: cannot copy a libtool object to \`$destfile'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Install the libtool object if requested.
+ if test -n "$destfile"; then
+ $show "$install_prog $file $destfile"
+ $run eval "$install_prog $file $destfile" || exit $?
+ fi
+
+ # Install the old object if enabled.
+ if test "$build_old_libs" = yes; then
+ # Deduce the name of the old-style object file.
+ staticobj=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e "$lo2o"`
+
+ $show "$install_prog $staticobj $staticdest"
+ $run eval "$install_prog \$staticobj \$staticdest" || exit $?
+ fi
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ # Figure out destination file name, if it wasn't already specified.
+ if test -n "$destname"; then
+ destfile="$destdir/$destname"
+ else
+ destfile=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ destfile="$destdir/$destfile"
+ fi
+
+ # If the file is missing, and there is a .exe on the end, strip it
+ # because it is most likely a libtool script we actually want to
+ # install
+ stripped_ext=""
+ case $file in
+ *.exe)
+ if test ! -f "$file"; then
+ file=`$echo $file|${SED} 's,.exe$,,'`
+ stripped_ext=".exe"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Do a test to see if this is really a libtool program.
+ case $host in
+ *cygwin*|*mingw*)
+ wrapper=`$echo $file | ${SED} -e 's,.exe$,,'`
+ ;;
+ *)
+ wrapper=$file
+ ;;
+ esac
+ if (${SED} -e '4q' $wrapper | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE")>/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ notinst_deplibs=
+ relink_command=
+
+ # To insure that "foo" is sourced, and not "foo.exe",
+ # finese the cygwin/MSYS system by explicitly sourcing "foo."
+ # which disallows the automatic-append-.exe behavior.
+ case $build in
+ *cygwin* | *mingw*) wrapperdot=${wrapper}. ;;
+ *) wrapperdot=${wrapper} ;;
+ esac
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $file in
+ */* | *\\*) . ${wrapperdot} ;;
+ *) . ./${wrapperdot} ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Check the variables that should have been set.
+ if test -z "$notinst_deplibs"; then
+ $echo "$modename: invalid libtool wrapper script \`$wrapper'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ finalize=yes
+ for lib in $notinst_deplibs; do
+ # Check to see that each library is installed.
+ libdir=
+ if test -f "$lib"; then
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $lib in
+ */* | *\\*) . $lib ;;
+ *) . ./$lib ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ libfile="$libdir/"`$echo "X$lib" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%g'` ### testsuite: skip nested quoting test
+ if test -n "$libdir" && test ! -f "$libfile"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: \`$lib' has not been installed in \`$libdir'" 1>&2
+ finalize=no
+ fi
+ done
+
+ relink_command=
+ # To insure that "foo" is sourced, and not "foo.exe",
+ # finese the cygwin/MSYS system by explicitly sourcing "foo."
+ # which disallows the automatic-append-.exe behavior.
+ case $build in
+ *cygwin* | *mingw*) wrapperdot=${wrapper}. ;;
+ *) wrapperdot=${wrapper} ;;
+ esac
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $file in
+ */* | *\\*) . ${wrapperdot} ;;
+ *) . ./${wrapperdot} ;;
+ esac
+
+ outputname=
+ if test "$fast_install" = no && test -n "$relink_command"; then
+ if test "$finalize" = yes && test -z "$run"; then
+ tmpdir="/tmp"
+ test -n "$TMPDIR" && tmpdir="$TMPDIR"
+ tmpdir="$tmpdir/libtool-$$"
+ save_umask=`umask`
+ umask 0077
+ if $mkdir "$tmpdir"; then
+ umask $save_umask
+ else
+ umask $save_umask
+ $echo "$modename: error: cannot create temporary directory \`$tmpdir'" 1>&2
+ continue
+ fi
+ file=`$echo "X$file$stripped_ext" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ outputname="$tmpdir/$file"
+ # Replace the output file specification.
+ relink_command=`$echo "X$relink_command" | $Xsed -e 's%@OUTPUT@%'"$outputname"'%g'`
+
+ $show "$relink_command"
+ if $run eval "$relink_command"; then :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: error: relink \`$file' with the above command before installing it" 1>&2
+ ${rm}r "$tmpdir"
+ continue
+ fi
+ file="$outputname"
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: warning: cannot relink \`$file'" 1>&2
+ fi
+ else
+ # Install the binary that we compiled earlier.
+ file=`$echo "X$file$stripped_ext" | $Xsed -e "s%\([^/]*\)$%$objdir/\1%"`
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ # remove .exe since cygwin /usr/bin/install will append another
+ # one anyways
+ case $install_prog,$host in
+ */usr/bin/install*,*cygwin*)
+ case $file:$destfile in
+ *.exe:*.exe)
+ # this is ok
+ ;;
+ *.exe:*)
+ destfile=$destfile.exe
+ ;;
+ *:*.exe)
+ destfile=`$echo $destfile | ${SED} -e 's,.exe$,,'`
+ ;;
+ esac
+ ;;
+ esac
+ $show "$install_prog$stripme $file $destfile"
+ $run eval "$install_prog\$stripme \$file \$destfile" || exit $?
+ test -n "$outputname" && ${rm}r "$tmpdir"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ for file in $staticlibs; do
+ name=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+
+ # Set up the ranlib parameters.
+ oldlib="$destdir/$name"
+
+ $show "$install_prog $file $oldlib"
+ $run eval "$install_prog \$file \$oldlib" || exit $?
+
+ if test -n "$stripme" && test -n "$old_striplib"; then
+ $show "$old_striplib $oldlib"
+ $run eval "$old_striplib $oldlib" || exit $?
+ fi
+
+ # Do each command in the postinstall commands.
+ cmds=$old_postinstall_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || exit $?
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ done
+
+ if test -n "$future_libdirs"; then
+ $echo "$modename: warning: remember to run \`$progname --finish$future_libdirs'" 1>&2
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$current_libdirs"; then
+ # Maybe just do a dry run.
+ test -n "$run" && current_libdirs=" -n$current_libdirs"
+ exec_cmd='$SHELL $progpath $preserve_args --finish$current_libdirs'
+ else
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ # libtool finish mode
+ finish)
+ modename="$modename: finish"
+ libdirs="$nonopt"
+ admincmds=
+
+ if test -n "$finish_cmds$finish_eval" && test -n "$libdirs"; then
+ for dir
+ do
+ libdirs="$libdirs $dir"
+ done
+
+ for libdir in $libdirs; do
+ if test -n "$finish_cmds"; then
+ # Do each command in the finish commands.
+ cmds=$finish_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd" || admincmds="$admincmds
+ $cmd"
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+ if test -n "$finish_eval"; then
+ # Do the single finish_eval.
+ eval cmds=\"$finish_eval\"
+ $run eval "$cmds" || admincmds="$admincmds
+ $cmds"
+ fi
+ done
+ fi
+
+ # Exit here if they wanted silent mode.
+ test "$show" = : && exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+
+ $echo "----------------------------------------------------------------------"
+ $echo "Libraries have been installed in:"
+ for libdir in $libdirs; do
+ $echo " $libdir"
+ done
+ $echo
+ $echo "If you ever happen to want to link against installed libraries"
+ $echo "in a given directory, LIBDIR, you must either use libtool, and"
+ $echo "specify the full pathname of the library, or use the \`-LLIBDIR'"
+ $echo "flag during linking and do at least one of the following:"
+ if test -n "$shlibpath_var"; then
+ $echo " - add LIBDIR to the \`$shlibpath_var' environment variable"
+ $echo " during execution"
+ fi
+ if test -n "$runpath_var"; then
+ $echo " - add LIBDIR to the \`$runpath_var' environment variable"
+ $echo " during linking"
+ fi
+ if test -n "$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec"; then
+ libdir=LIBDIR
+ eval flag=\"$hardcode_libdir_flag_spec\"
+
+ $echo " - use the \`$flag' linker flag"
+ fi
+ if test -n "$admincmds"; then
+ $echo " - have your system administrator run these commands:$admincmds"
+ fi
+ if test -f /etc/ld.so.conf; then
+ $echo " - have your system administrator add LIBDIR to \`/etc/ld.so.conf'"
+ fi
+ $echo
+ $echo "See any operating system documentation about shared libraries for"
+ $echo "more information, such as the ld(1) and ld.so(8) manual pages."
+ $echo "----------------------------------------------------------------------"
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+ # libtool execute mode
+ execute)
+ modename="$modename: execute"
+
+ # The first argument is the command name.
+ cmd="$nonopt"
+ if test -z "$cmd"; then
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify a COMMAND" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help"
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Handle -dlopen flags immediately.
+ for file in $execute_dlfiles; do
+ if test ! -f "$file"; then
+ $echo "$modename: \`$file' is not a file" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ dir=
+ case $file in
+ *.la)
+ # Check to see that this really is a libtool archive.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $file | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then :
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: \`$lib' is not a valid libtool archive" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ # Read the libtool library.
+ dlname=
+ library_names=
+
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $file in
+ */* | *\\*) . $file ;;
+ *) . ./$file ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Skip this library if it cannot be dlopened.
+ if test -z "$dlname"; then
+ # Warn if it was a shared library.
+ test -n "$library_names" && $echo "$modename: warning: \`$file' was not linked with \`-export-dynamic'"
+ continue
+ fi
+
+ dir=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ test "X$dir" = "X$file" && dir=.
+
+ if test -f "$dir/$objdir/$dlname"; then
+ dir="$dir/$objdir"
+ else
+ $echo "$modename: cannot find \`$dlname' in \`$dir' or \`$dir/$objdir'" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ *.lo)
+ # Just add the directory containing the .lo file.
+ dir=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ test "X$dir" = "X$file" && dir=.
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ $echo "$modename: warning \`-dlopen' is ignored for non-libtool libraries and objects" 1>&2
+ continue
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Get the absolute pathname.
+ absdir=`cd "$dir" && pwd`
+ test -n "$absdir" && dir="$absdir"
+
+ # Now add the directory to shlibpath_var.
+ if eval "test -z \"\$$shlibpath_var\""; then
+ eval "$shlibpath_var=\"\$dir\""
+ else
+ eval "$shlibpath_var=\"\$dir:\$$shlibpath_var\""
+ fi
+ done
+
+ # This variable tells wrapper scripts just to set shlibpath_var
+ # rather than running their programs.
+ libtool_execute_magic="$magic"
+
+ # Check if any of the arguments is a wrapper script.
+ args=
+ for file
+ do
+ case $file in
+ -*) ;;
+ *)
+ # Do a test to see if this is really a libtool program.
+ if (${SED} -e '4q' $file | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ # If there is no directory component, then add one.
+ case $file in
+ */* | *\\*) . $file ;;
+ *) . ./$file ;;
+ esac
+
+ # Transform arg to wrapped name.
+ file="$progdir/$program"
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ # Quote arguments (to preserve shell metacharacters).
+ file=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e "$sed_quote_subst"`
+ args="$args \"$file\""
+ done
+
+ if test -z "$run"; then
+ if test -n "$shlibpath_var"; then
+ # Export the shlibpath_var.
+ eval "export $shlibpath_var"
+ fi
+
+ # Restore saved environment variables
+ if test "${save_LC_ALL+set}" = set; then
+ LC_ALL="$save_LC_ALL"; export LC_ALL
+ fi
+ if test "${save_LANG+set}" = set; then
+ LANG="$save_LANG"; export LANG
+ fi
+
+ # Now prepare to actually exec the command.
+ exec_cmd="\$cmd$args"
+ else
+ # Display what would be done.
+ if test -n "$shlibpath_var"; then
+ eval "\$echo \"\$shlibpath_var=\$$shlibpath_var\""
+ $echo "export $shlibpath_var"
+ fi
+ $echo "$cmd$args"
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ # libtool clean and uninstall mode
+ clean | uninstall)
+ modename="$modename: $mode"
+ rm="$nonopt"
+ files=
+ rmforce=
+ exit_status=0
+
+ # This variable tells wrapper scripts just to set variables rather
+ # than running their programs.
+ libtool_install_magic="$magic"
+
+ for arg
+ do
+ case $arg in
+ -f) rm="$rm $arg"; rmforce=yes ;;
+ -*) rm="$rm $arg" ;;
+ *) files="$files $arg" ;;
+ esac
+ done
+
+ if test -z "$rm"; then
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify an RM program" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+
+ rmdirs=
+
+ origobjdir="$objdir"
+ for file in $files; do
+ dir=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%/[^/]*$%%'`
+ if test "X$dir" = "X$file"; then
+ dir=.
+ objdir="$origobjdir"
+ else
+ objdir="$dir/$origobjdir"
+ fi
+ name=`$echo "X$file" | $Xsed -e 's%^.*/%%'`
+ test "$mode" = uninstall && objdir="$dir"
+
+ # Remember objdir for removal later, being careful to avoid duplicates
+ if test "$mode" = clean; then
+ case " $rmdirs " in
+ *" $objdir "*) ;;
+ *) rmdirs="$rmdirs $objdir" ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ # Don't error if the file doesn't exist and rm -f was used.
+ if (test -L "$file") >/dev/null 2>&1 \
+ || (test -h "$file") >/dev/null 2>&1 \
+ || test -f "$file"; then
+ :
+ elif test -d "$file"; then
+ exit_status=1
+ continue
+ elif test "$rmforce" = yes; then
+ continue
+ fi
+
+ rmfiles="$file"
+
+ case $name in
+ *.la)
+ # Possibly a libtool archive, so verify it.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $file | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ . $dir/$name
+
+ # Delete the libtool libraries and symlinks.
+ for n in $library_names; do
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $objdir/$n"
+ done
+ test -n "$old_library" && rmfiles="$rmfiles $objdir/$old_library"
+ test "$mode" = clean && rmfiles="$rmfiles $objdir/$name $objdir/${name}i"
+
+ if test "$mode" = uninstall; then
+ if test -n "$library_names"; then
+ # Do each command in the postuninstall commands.
+ cmds=$postuninstall_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd"
+ if test "$?" -ne 0 && test "$rmforce" != yes; then
+ exit_status=1
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+
+ if test -n "$old_library"; then
+ # Do each command in the old_postuninstall commands.
+ cmds=$old_postuninstall_cmds
+ save_ifs="$IFS"; IFS='~'
+ for cmd in $cmds; do
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ eval cmd=\"$cmd\"
+ $show "$cmd"
+ $run eval "$cmd"
+ if test "$?" -ne 0 && test "$rmforce" != yes; then
+ exit_status=1
+ fi
+ done
+ IFS="$save_ifs"
+ fi
+ # FIXME: should reinstall the best remaining shared library.
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ *.lo)
+ # Possibly a libtool object, so verify it.
+ if (${SED} -e '2q' $file | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+
+ # Read the .lo file
+ . $dir/$name
+
+ # Add PIC object to the list of files to remove.
+ if test -n "$pic_object" \
+ && test "$pic_object" != none; then
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $dir/$pic_object"
+ fi
+
+ # Add non-PIC object to the list of files to remove.
+ if test -n "$non_pic_object" \
+ && test "$non_pic_object" != none; then
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $dir/$non_pic_object"
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ if test "$mode" = clean ; then
+ noexename=$name
+ case $file in
+ *.exe)
+ file=`$echo $file|${SED} 's,.exe$,,'`
+ noexename=`$echo $name|${SED} 's,.exe$,,'`
+ # $file with .exe has already been added to rmfiles,
+ # add $file without .exe
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $file"
+ ;;
+ esac
+ # Do a test to see if this is a libtool program.
+ if (${SED} -e '4q' $file | grep "^# Generated by .*$PACKAGE") >/dev/null 2>&1; then
+ relink_command=
+ . $dir/$noexename
+
+ # note $name still contains .exe if it was in $file originally
+ # as does the version of $file that was added into $rmfiles
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $objdir/$name $objdir/${name}S.${objext}"
+ if test "$fast_install" = yes && test -n "$relink_command"; then
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $objdir/lt-$name"
+ fi
+ if test "X$noexename" != "X$name" ; then
+ rmfiles="$rmfiles $objdir/lt-${noexename}.c"
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ $show "$rm $rmfiles"
+ $run $rm $rmfiles || exit_status=1
+ done
+ objdir="$origobjdir"
+
+ # Try to remove the ${objdir}s in the directories where we deleted files
+ for dir in $rmdirs; do
+ if test -d "$dir"; then
+ $show "rmdir $dir"
+ $run rmdir $dir >/dev/null 2>&1
+ fi
+ done
+
+ exit $exit_status
+ ;;
+
+ "")
+ $echo "$modename: you must specify a MODE" 1>&2
+ $echo "$generic_help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test -z "$exec_cmd"; then
+ $echo "$modename: invalid operation mode \`$mode'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$generic_help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ fi
+fi # test -z "$show_help"
+
+if test -n "$exec_cmd"; then
+ eval exec $exec_cmd
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+fi
+
+# We need to display help for each of the modes.
+case $mode in
+"") $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... [MODE-ARG]...
+
+Provide generalized library-building support services.
+
+ --config show all configuration variables
+ --debug enable verbose shell tracing
+-n, --dry-run display commands without modifying any files
+ --features display basic configuration information and exit
+ --finish same as \`--mode=finish'
+ --help display this help message and exit
+ --mode=MODE use operation mode MODE [default=inferred from MODE-ARGS]
+ --quiet same as \`--silent'
+ --silent don't print informational messages
+ --tag=TAG use configuration variables from tag TAG
+ --version print version information
+
+MODE must be one of the following:
+
+ clean remove files from the build directory
+ compile compile a source file into a libtool object
+ execute automatically set library path, then run a program
+ finish complete the installation of libtool libraries
+ install install libraries or executables
+ link create a library or an executable
+ uninstall remove libraries from an installed directory
+
+MODE-ARGS vary depending on the MODE. Try \`$modename --help --mode=MODE' for
+a more detailed description of MODE.
+
+Report bugs to <bug-libtool@gnu.org>."
+ exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+ ;;
+
+clean)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=clean RM [RM-OPTION]... FILE...
+
+Remove files from the build directory.
+
+RM is the name of the program to use to delete files associated with each FILE
+(typically \`/bin/rm'). RM-OPTIONS are options (such as \`-f') to be passed
+to RM.
+
+If FILE is a libtool library, object or program, all the files associated
+with it are deleted. Otherwise, only FILE itself is deleted using RM."
+ ;;
+
+compile)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=compile COMPILE-COMMAND... SOURCEFILE
+
+Compile a source file into a libtool library object.
+
+This mode accepts the following additional options:
+
+ -o OUTPUT-FILE set the output file name to OUTPUT-FILE
+ -prefer-pic try to building PIC objects only
+ -prefer-non-pic try to building non-PIC objects only
+ -static always build a \`.o' file suitable for static linking
+
+COMPILE-COMMAND is a command to be used in creating a \`standard' object file
+from the given SOURCEFILE.
+
+The output file name is determined by removing the directory component from
+SOURCEFILE, then substituting the C source code suffix \`.c' with the
+library object suffix, \`.lo'."
+ ;;
+
+execute)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=execute COMMAND [ARGS]...
+
+Automatically set library path, then run a program.
+
+This mode accepts the following additional options:
+
+ -dlopen FILE add the directory containing FILE to the library path
+
+This mode sets the library path environment variable according to \`-dlopen'
+flags.
+
+If any of the ARGS are libtool executable wrappers, then they are translated
+into their corresponding uninstalled binary, and any of their required library
+directories are added to the library path.
+
+Then, COMMAND is executed, with ARGS as arguments."
+ ;;
+
+finish)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=finish [LIBDIR]...
+
+Complete the installation of libtool libraries.
+
+Each LIBDIR is a directory that contains libtool libraries.
+
+The commands that this mode executes may require superuser privileges. Use
+the \`--dry-run' option if you just want to see what would be executed."
+ ;;
+
+install)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=install INSTALL-COMMAND...
+
+Install executables or libraries.
+
+INSTALL-COMMAND is the installation command. The first component should be
+either the \`install' or \`cp' program.
+
+The rest of the components are interpreted as arguments to that command (only
+BSD-compatible install options are recognized)."
+ ;;
+
+link)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=link LINK-COMMAND...
+
+Link object files or libraries together to form another library, or to
+create an executable program.
+
+LINK-COMMAND is a command using the C compiler that you would use to create
+a program from several object files.
+
+The following components of LINK-COMMAND are treated specially:
+
+ -all-static do not do any dynamic linking at all
+ -avoid-version do not add a version suffix if possible
+ -dlopen FILE \`-dlpreopen' FILE if it cannot be dlopened at runtime
+ -dlpreopen FILE link in FILE and add its symbols to lt_preloaded_symbols
+ -export-dynamic allow symbols from OUTPUT-FILE to be resolved with dlsym(3)
+ -export-symbols SYMFILE
+ try to export only the symbols listed in SYMFILE
+ -export-symbols-regex REGEX
+ try to export only the symbols matching REGEX
+ -LLIBDIR search LIBDIR for required installed libraries
+ -lNAME OUTPUT-FILE requires the installed library libNAME
+ -module build a library that can dlopened
+ -no-fast-install disable the fast-install mode
+ -no-install link a not-installable executable
+ -no-undefined declare that a library does not refer to external symbols
+ -o OUTPUT-FILE create OUTPUT-FILE from the specified objects
+ -objectlist FILE Use a list of object files found in FILE to specify objects
+ -precious-files-regex REGEX
+ don't remove output files matching REGEX
+ -release RELEASE specify package release information
+ -rpath LIBDIR the created library will eventually be installed in LIBDIR
+ -R[ ]LIBDIR add LIBDIR to the runtime path of programs and libraries
+ -static do not do any dynamic linking of libtool libraries
+ -version-info CURRENT[:REVISION[:AGE]]
+ specify library version info [each variable defaults to 0]
+
+All other options (arguments beginning with \`-') are ignored.
+
+Every other argument is treated as a filename. Files ending in \`.la' are
+treated as uninstalled libtool libraries, other files are standard or library
+object files.
+
+If the OUTPUT-FILE ends in \`.la', then a libtool library is created,
+only library objects (\`.lo' files) may be specified, and \`-rpath' is
+required, except when creating a convenience library.
+
+If OUTPUT-FILE ends in \`.a' or \`.lib', then a standard library is created
+using \`ar' and \`ranlib', or on Windows using \`lib'.
+
+If OUTPUT-FILE ends in \`.lo' or \`.${objext}', then a reloadable object file
+is created, otherwise an executable program is created."
+ ;;
+
+uninstall)
+ $echo \
+"Usage: $modename [OPTION]... --mode=uninstall RM [RM-OPTION]... FILE...
+
+Remove libraries from an installation directory.
+
+RM is the name of the program to use to delete files associated with each FILE
+(typically \`/bin/rm'). RM-OPTIONS are options (such as \`-f') to be passed
+to RM.
+
+If FILE is a libtool library, all the files associated with it are deleted.
+Otherwise, only FILE itself is deleted using RM."
+ ;;
+
+*)
+ $echo "$modename: invalid operation mode \`$mode'" 1>&2
+ $echo "$help" 1>&2
+ exit $EXIT_FAILURE
+ ;;
+esac
+
+$echo
+$echo "Try \`$modename --help' for more information about other modes."
+
+exit $EXIT_SUCCESS
+
+# The TAGs below are defined such that we never get into a situation
+# in which we disable both kinds of libraries. Given conflicting
+# choices, we go for a static library, that is the most portable,
+# since we can't tell whether shared libraries were disabled because
+# the user asked for that or because the platform doesn't support
+# them. This is particularly important on AIX, because we don't
+# support having both static and shared libraries enabled at the same
+# time on that platform, so we default to a shared-only configuration.
+# If a disable-shared tag is given, we'll fallback to a static-only
+# configuration. But we'll never go from static-only to shared-only.
+
+# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: disable-shared
+build_libtool_libs=no
+build_old_libs=yes
+# ### END LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: disable-shared
+
+# ### BEGIN LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: disable-static
+build_old_libs=`case $build_libtool_libs in yes) $echo no;; *) $echo yes;; esac`
+# ### END LIBTOOL TAG CONFIG: disable-static
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode:shell-script
+# sh-indentation:2
+# End:
diff --git a/config/missing b/config/missing
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..894e786e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/missing
@@ -0,0 +1,360 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# Common stub for a few missing GNU programs while installing.
+
+scriptversion=2005-06-08.21
+
+# Copyright (C) 1996, 1997, 1999, 2000, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005
+# Free Software Foundation, Inc.
+# Originally by Fran,cois Pinard <pinard@iro.umontreal.ca>, 1996.
+
+# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
+# it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
+# the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
+# any later version.
+
+# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
+# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
+# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
+# GNU General Public License for more details.
+
+# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
+# Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
+# 02110-1301, USA.
+
+# As a special exception to the GNU General Public License, if you
+# distribute this file as part of a program that contains a
+# configuration script generated by Autoconf, you may include it under
+# the same distribution terms that you use for the rest of that program.
+
+if test $# -eq 0; then
+ echo 1>&2 "Try \`$0 --help' for more information"
+ exit 1
+fi
+
+run=:
+
+# In the cases where this matters, `missing' is being run in the
+# srcdir already.
+if test -f configure.ac; then
+ configure_ac=configure.ac
+else
+ configure_ac=configure.in
+fi
+
+msg="missing on your system"
+
+case "$1" in
+--run)
+ # Try to run requested program, and just exit if it succeeds.
+ run=
+ shift
+ "$@" && exit 0
+ # Exit code 63 means version mismatch. This often happens
+ # when the user try to use an ancient version of a tool on
+ # a file that requires a minimum version. In this case we
+ # we should proceed has if the program had been absent, or
+ # if --run hadn't been passed.
+ if test $? = 63; then
+ run=:
+ msg="probably too old"
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ -h|--h|--he|--hel|--help)
+ echo "\
+$0 [OPTION]... PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]...
+
+Handle \`PROGRAM [ARGUMENT]...' for when PROGRAM is missing, or return an
+error status if there is no known handling for PROGRAM.
+
+Options:
+ -h, --help display this help and exit
+ -v, --version output version information and exit
+ --run try to run the given command, and emulate it if it fails
+
+Supported PROGRAM values:
+ aclocal touch file \`aclocal.m4'
+ autoconf touch file \`configure'
+ autoheader touch file \`config.h.in'
+ automake touch all \`Makefile.in' files
+ bison create \`y.tab.[ch]', if possible, from existing .[ch]
+ flex create \`lex.yy.c', if possible, from existing .c
+ help2man touch the output file
+ lex create \`lex.yy.c', if possible, from existing .c
+ makeinfo touch the output file
+ tar try tar, gnutar, gtar, then tar without non-portable flags
+ yacc create \`y.tab.[ch]', if possible, from existing .[ch]
+
+Send bug reports to <bug-automake@gnu.org>."
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+
+ -v|--v|--ve|--ver|--vers|--versi|--versio|--version)
+ echo "missing $scriptversion (GNU Automake)"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+
+ -*)
+ echo 1>&2 "$0: Unknown \`$1' option"
+ echo 1>&2 "Try \`$0 --help' for more information"
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+
+esac
+
+# Now exit if we have it, but it failed. Also exit now if we
+# don't have it and --version was passed (most likely to detect
+# the program).
+case "$1" in
+ lex|yacc)
+ # Not GNU programs, they don't have --version.
+ ;;
+
+ tar)
+ if test -n "$run"; then
+ echo 1>&2 "ERROR: \`tar' requires --run"
+ exit 1
+ elif test "x$2" = "x--version" || test "x$2" = "x--help"; then
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ if test -z "$run" && ($1 --version) > /dev/null 2>&1; then
+ # We have it, but it failed.
+ exit 1
+ elif test "x$2" = "x--version" || test "x$2" = "x--help"; then
+ # Could not run --version or --help. This is probably someone
+ # running `$TOOL --version' or `$TOOL --help' to check whether
+ # $TOOL exists and not knowing $TOOL uses missing.
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ ;;
+esac
+
+# If it does not exist, or fails to run (possibly an outdated version),
+# try to emulate it.
+case "$1" in
+ aclocal*)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified \`acinclude.m4' or \`${configure_ac}'. You might want
+ to install the \`Automake' and \`Perl' packages. Grab them from
+ any GNU archive site."
+ touch aclocal.m4
+ ;;
+
+ autoconf)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified \`${configure_ac}'. You might want to install the
+ \`Autoconf' and \`GNU m4' packages. Grab them from any GNU
+ archive site."
+ touch configure
+ ;;
+
+ autoheader)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified \`acconfig.h' or \`${configure_ac}'. You might want
+ to install the \`Autoconf' and \`GNU m4' packages. Grab them
+ from any GNU archive site."
+ files=`sed -n 's/^[ ]*A[CM]_CONFIG_HEADER(\([^)]*\)).*/\1/p' ${configure_ac}`
+ test -z "$files" && files="config.h"
+ touch_files=
+ for f in $files; do
+ case "$f" in
+ *:*) touch_files="$touch_files "`echo "$f" |
+ sed -e 's/^[^:]*://' -e 's/:.*//'`;;
+ *) touch_files="$touch_files $f.in";;
+ esac
+ done
+ touch $touch_files
+ ;;
+
+ automake*)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified \`Makefile.am', \`acinclude.m4' or \`${configure_ac}'.
+ You might want to install the \`Automake' and \`Perl' packages.
+ Grab them from any GNU archive site."
+ find . -type f -name Makefile.am -print |
+ sed 's/\.am$/.in/' |
+ while read f; do touch "$f"; done
+ ;;
+
+ autom4te)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is needed, but is $msg.
+ You might have modified some files without having the
+ proper tools for further handling them.
+ You can get \`$1' as part of \`Autoconf' from any GNU
+ archive site."
+
+ file=`echo "$*" | sed -n 's/.*--output[ =]*\([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'`
+ test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$*" | sed -n 's/.*-o[ ]*\([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'`
+ if test -f "$file"; then
+ touch $file
+ else
+ test -z "$file" || exec >$file
+ echo "#! /bin/sh"
+ echo "# Created by GNU Automake missing as a replacement of"
+ echo "# $ $@"
+ echo "exit 0"
+ chmod +x $file
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ bison|yacc)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified a \`.y' file. You may need the \`Bison' package
+ in order for those modifications to take effect. You can get
+ \`Bison' from any GNU archive site."
+ rm -f y.tab.c y.tab.h
+ if [ $# -ne 1 ]; then
+ eval LASTARG="\${$#}"
+ case "$LASTARG" in
+ *.y)
+ SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/y$/c/'`
+ if [ -f "$SRCFILE" ]; then
+ cp "$SRCFILE" y.tab.c
+ fi
+ SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/y$/h/'`
+ if [ -f "$SRCFILE" ]; then
+ cp "$SRCFILE" y.tab.h
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if [ ! -f y.tab.h ]; then
+ echo >y.tab.h
+ fi
+ if [ ! -f y.tab.c ]; then
+ echo 'main() { return 0; }' >y.tab.c
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ lex|flex)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified a \`.l' file. You may need the \`Flex' package
+ in order for those modifications to take effect. You can get
+ \`Flex' from any GNU archive site."
+ rm -f lex.yy.c
+ if [ $# -ne 1 ]; then
+ eval LASTARG="\${$#}"
+ case "$LASTARG" in
+ *.l)
+ SRCFILE=`echo "$LASTARG" | sed 's/l$/c/'`
+ if [ -f "$SRCFILE" ]; then
+ cp "$SRCFILE" lex.yy.c
+ fi
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+ if [ ! -f lex.yy.c ]; then
+ echo 'main() { return 0; }' >lex.yy.c
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ help2man)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified a dependency of a manual page. You may need the
+ \`Help2man' package in order for those modifications to take
+ effect. You can get \`Help2man' from any GNU archive site."
+
+ file=`echo "$*" | sed -n 's/.*-o \([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'`
+ if test -z "$file"; then
+ file=`echo "$*" | sed -n 's/.*--output=\([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'`
+ fi
+ if [ -f "$file" ]; then
+ touch $file
+ else
+ test -z "$file" || exec >$file
+ echo ".ab help2man is required to generate this page"
+ exit 1
+ fi
+ ;;
+
+ makeinfo)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is $msg. You should only need it if
+ you modified a \`.texi' or \`.texinfo' file, or any other file
+ indirectly affecting the aspect of the manual. The spurious
+ call might also be the consequence of using a buggy \`make' (AIX,
+ DU, IRIX). You might want to install the \`Texinfo' package or
+ the \`GNU make' package. Grab either from any GNU archive site."
+ # The file to touch is that specified with -o ...
+ file=`echo "$*" | sed -n 's/.*-o \([^ ]*\).*/\1/p'`
+ if test -z "$file"; then
+ # ... or it is the one specified with @setfilename ...
+ infile=`echo "$*" | sed 's/.* \([^ ]*\) *$/\1/'`
+ file=`sed -n '/^@setfilename/ { s/.* \([^ ]*\) *$/\1/; p; q; }' $infile`
+ # ... or it is derived from the source name (dir/f.texi becomes f.info)
+ test -z "$file" && file=`echo "$infile" | sed 's,.*/,,;s,.[^.]*$,,'`.info
+ fi
+ # If the file does not exist, the user really needs makeinfo;
+ # let's fail without touching anything.
+ test -f $file || exit 1
+ touch $file
+ ;;
+
+ tar)
+ shift
+
+ # We have already tried tar in the generic part.
+ # Look for gnutar/gtar before invocation to avoid ugly error
+ # messages.
+ if (gnutar --version > /dev/null 2>&1); then
+ gnutar "$@" && exit 0
+ fi
+ if (gtar --version > /dev/null 2>&1); then
+ gtar "$@" && exit 0
+ fi
+ firstarg="$1"
+ if shift; then
+ case "$firstarg" in
+ *o*)
+ firstarg=`echo "$firstarg" | sed s/o//`
+ tar "$firstarg" "$@" && exit 0
+ ;;
+ esac
+ case "$firstarg" in
+ *h*)
+ firstarg=`echo "$firstarg" | sed s/h//`
+ tar "$firstarg" "$@" && exit 0
+ ;;
+ esac
+ fi
+
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: I can't seem to be able to run \`tar' with the given arguments.
+ You may want to install GNU tar or Free paxutils, or check the
+ command line arguments."
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+
+ *)
+ echo 1>&2 "\
+WARNING: \`$1' is needed, and is $msg.
+ You might have modified some files without having the
+ proper tools for further handling them. Check the \`README' file,
+ it often tells you about the needed prerequisites for installing
+ this package. You may also peek at any GNU archive site, in case
+ some other package would contain this missing \`$1' program."
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+esac
+
+exit 0
+
+# Local variables:
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# End:
diff --git a/config/mkinstalldirs b/config/mkinstalldirs
new file mode 100755
index 00000000..259dbfcd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/mkinstalldirs
@@ -0,0 +1,158 @@
+#! /bin/sh
+# mkinstalldirs --- make directory hierarchy
+
+scriptversion=2005-06-29.22
+
+# Original author: Noah Friedman <friedman@prep.ai.mit.edu>
+# Created: 1993-05-16
+# Public domain.
+#
+# This file is maintained in Automake, please report
+# bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org> or send patches to
+# <automake-patches@gnu.org>.
+
+errstatus=0
+dirmode=
+
+usage="\
+Usage: mkinstalldirs [-h] [--help] [--version] [-m MODE] DIR ...
+
+Create each directory DIR (with mode MODE, if specified), including all
+leading file name components.
+
+Report bugs to <bug-automake@gnu.org>."
+
+# process command line arguments
+while test $# -gt 0 ; do
+ case $1 in
+ -h | --help | --h*) # -h for help
+ echo "$usage"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ -m) # -m PERM arg
+ shift
+ test $# -eq 0 && { echo "$usage" 1>&2; exit 1; }
+ dirmode=$1
+ shift
+ ;;
+ --version)
+ echo "$0 $scriptversion"
+ exit $?
+ ;;
+ --) # stop option processing
+ shift
+ break
+ ;;
+ -*) # unknown option
+ echo "$usage" 1>&2
+ exit 1
+ ;;
+ *) # first non-opt arg
+ break
+ ;;
+ esac
+done
+
+for file
+do
+ if test -d "$file"; then
+ shift
+ else
+ break
+ fi
+done
+
+case $# in
+ 0) exit 0 ;;
+esac
+
+# Solaris 8's mkdir -p isn't thread-safe. If you mkdir -p a/b and
+# mkdir -p a/c at the same time, both will detect that a is missing,
+# one will create a, then the other will try to create a and die with
+# a "File exists" error. This is a problem when calling mkinstalldirs
+# from a parallel make. We use --version in the probe to restrict
+# ourselves to GNU mkdir, which is thread-safe.
+case $dirmode in
+ '')
+ if mkdir -p --version . >/dev/null 2>&1 && test ! -d ./--version; then
+ echo "mkdir -p -- $*"
+ exec mkdir -p -- "$@"
+ else
+ # On NextStep and OpenStep, the `mkdir' command does not
+ # recognize any option. It will interpret all options as
+ # directories to create, and then abort because `.' already
+ # exists.
+ test -d ./-p && rmdir ./-p
+ test -d ./--version && rmdir ./--version
+ fi
+ ;;
+ *)
+ if mkdir -m "$dirmode" -p --version . >/dev/null 2>&1 &&
+ test ! -d ./--version; then
+ echo "mkdir -m $dirmode -p -- $*"
+ exec mkdir -m "$dirmode" -p -- "$@"
+ else
+ # Clean up after NextStep and OpenStep mkdir.
+ for d in ./-m ./-p ./--version "./$dirmode";
+ do
+ test -d $d && rmdir $d
+ done
+ fi
+ ;;
+esac
+
+for file
+do
+ case $file in
+ /*) pathcomp=/ ;;
+ *) pathcomp= ;;
+ esac
+ oIFS=$IFS
+ IFS=/
+ set fnord $file
+ shift
+ IFS=$oIFS
+
+ for d
+ do
+ test "x$d" = x && continue
+
+ pathcomp=$pathcomp$d
+ case $pathcomp in
+ -*) pathcomp=./$pathcomp ;;
+ esac
+
+ if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
+ echo "mkdir $pathcomp"
+
+ mkdir "$pathcomp" || lasterr=$?
+
+ if test ! -d "$pathcomp"; then
+ errstatus=$lasterr
+ else
+ if test ! -z "$dirmode"; then
+ echo "chmod $dirmode $pathcomp"
+ lasterr=
+ chmod "$dirmode" "$pathcomp" || lasterr=$?
+
+ if test ! -z "$lasterr"; then
+ errstatus=$lasterr
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+ fi
+
+ pathcomp=$pathcomp/
+ done
+done
+
+exit $errstatus
+
+# Local Variables:
+# mode: shell-script
+# sh-indentation: 2
+# eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+# time-stamp-start: "scriptversion="
+# time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+# time-stamp-end: "$"
+# End:
diff --git a/config/texinfo.tex b/config/texinfo.tex
new file mode 100644
index 00000000..ff2c4065
--- /dev/null
+++ b/config/texinfo.tex
@@ -0,0 +1,7210 @@
+% texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
+%
+% Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
+\expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
+%
+\def\texinfoversion{2005-07-05.19}
+%
+% Copyright (C) 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
+% 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005 Free Software
+% Foundation, Inc.
+%
+% This texinfo.tex file is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
+% modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
+% published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at
+% your option) any later version.
+%
+% This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
+% useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
+% of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
+% General Public License for more details.
+%
+% You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
+% along with this texinfo.tex file; see the file COPYING. If not, write
+% to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
+% Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA.
+%
+% As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
+% a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
+% restriction. (This has been our intent since Texinfo was invented.)
+%
+% Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
+% reports; you can get the latest version from:
+% http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page), or
+% ftp://tug.org/tex/texinfo.tex
+% (and all CTAN mirrors, see http://www.ctan.org).
+% The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
+% of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
+%
+% Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
+% complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
+% problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
+%
+% To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
+% texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
+% manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
+% tex foo.texi
+% texindex foo.??
+% tex foo.texi
+% tex foo.texi
+% dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
+% The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
+% Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
+% than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
+%
+% It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
+% extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
+% full Texinfo distribution.
+%
+% The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
+
+
+\message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
+
+% If in a .fmt file, print the version number
+% and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
+% they might have appeared in the input file name.
+\everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
+ \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
+
+\message{Basics,}
+\chardef\other=12
+
+% We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
+% For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
+\let\+ = \relax
+
+% Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
+\let\ptexb=\b
+\let\ptexbullet=\bullet
+\let\ptexc=\c
+\let\ptexcomma=\,
+\let\ptexdot=\.
+\let\ptexdots=\dots
+\let\ptexend=\end
+\let\ptexequiv=\equiv
+\let\ptexexclam=\!
+\let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
+\let\ptexgtr=>
+\let\ptexhat=^
+\let\ptexi=\i
+\let\ptexindent=\indent
+\let\ptexinsert=\insert
+\let\ptexlbrace=\{
+\let\ptexless=<
+\let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
+\let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
+\let\ptexplus=+
+\let\ptexrbrace=\}
+\let\ptexslash=\/
+\let\ptexstar=\*
+\let\ptext=\t
+
+% If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
+% starts a new line in the output.
+\newlinechar = `^^J
+
+% Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
+% messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
+%
+\ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
+ \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
+\else
+ \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
+\fi
+
+% Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
+\ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
+\ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
+\ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
+\ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
+\ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
+\ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
+\ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
+\ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
+\ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
+\ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
+\ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
+\ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
+\ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
+\ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
+\ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
+\ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
+\ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
+\ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
+%
+\ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
+\ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
+%
+\ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
+\ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
+\ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
+\ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
+\ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
+
+% In some macros, we cannot use the `\? notation---the left quote is
+% in some cases the escape char.
+\chardef\backChar = `\\
+\chardef\colonChar = `\:
+\chardef\commaChar = `\,
+\chardef\dotChar = `\.
+\chardef\exclamChar= `\!
+\chardef\plusChar = `\+
+\chardef\questChar = `\?
+\chardef\semiChar = `\;
+\chardef\underChar = `\_
+
+\chardef\spaceChar = `\ %
+\chardef\spacecat = 10
+\def\spaceisspace{\catcode\spaceChar=\spacecat}
+
+{% for help with debugging.
+ % example usage: \expandafter\show\activebackslash
+ \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \active
+ !global!def!activebackslash{\}
+}
+
+% Ignore a token.
+%
+\def\gobble#1{}
+
+% The following is used inside several \edef's.
+\def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
+
+% Hyphenation fixes.
+\hyphenation{
+ Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
+ ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
+ data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
+ man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
+ par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
+ spell-ing spell-ings
+ stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
+ wide-spread wrap-around
+}
+
+% Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
+\newdimen\bindingoffset
+\newdimen\normaloffset
+\newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
+
+% For a final copy, take out the rectangles
+% that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
+% that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
+%
+\def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt}
+
+% @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
+% surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
+% change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
+% have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
+% vertical list for the beginning and end of each change).
+%
+\def\|{%
+ % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
+ \leavevmode
+ %
+ % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
+ \vadjust{%
+ % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
+ % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
+ \vskip-\baselineskip
+ %
+ % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
+ % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
+ \llap{%
+ %
+ % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
+ \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
+ %
+ % This is the space between the bar and the text.
+ \hskip 12pt
+ }%
+ }%
+}
+
+% Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
+% and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
+% since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
+% some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
+% file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
+%
+\def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
+\def\loggingall{%
+ \tracingstats2
+ \tracingpages1
+ \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
+ \tracingparagraphs1
+ \tracingoutput1
+ \tracingmacros2
+ \tracingrestores1
+ \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
+ \ifx\eTeXversion\undefined\else % etex gives us more logging
+ \tracingscantokens1
+ \tracingifs1
+ \tracinggroups1
+ \tracingnesting2
+ \tracingassigns1
+ \fi
+ \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
+ \errorcontextlines16
+}%
+
+% add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
+% we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
+%
+\def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
+ \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
+\def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
+ \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
+\def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
+ \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
+
+% For @cropmarks command.
+% Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
+%
+\newif\ifcropmarks
+\let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
+%
+% Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
+% Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
+%
+\newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
+\newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
+\newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
+\newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
+
+% Main output routine.
+\chardef\PAGE = 255
+\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
+
+\newbox\headlinebox
+\newbox\footlinebox
+
+% \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
+% does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
+\def\onepageout#1{%
+ \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
+ %
+ \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
+ \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
+ %
+ % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
+ % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
+ \setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makeheadline}%
+ \setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \makefootline}%
+ %
+ {%
+ % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
+ % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
+ % before the \shipout runs.
+ %
+ \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
+ \shipout\vbox{%
+ % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
+ \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
+ %
+ \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
+ \hsize = \outerhsize
+ \vskip-\topandbottommargin
+ \vtop to0pt{%
+ \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
+ \nointerlineskip
+ \line{%
+ \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
+ \hfill
+ \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
+ }%
+ \vss}%
+ \vskip\topandbottommargin
+ \line\bgroup
+ \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
+ \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \fi
+ %
+ \unvbox\headlinebox
+ \pagebody{#1}%
+ \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
+ % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
+ % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingxxx.)
+ % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
+ \vskip 2\baselineskip
+ \unvbox\footlinebox
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifcropmarks
+ \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
+ \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
+ \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
+ \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
+ \vbox to0pt{\vss
+ \line{%
+ \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
+ \hfill
+ \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
+ }%
+ \nointerlineskip
+ \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
+ }%
+ \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
+ \fi
+ }% end of \shipout\vbox
+ }% end of group with \indexdummies
+ \advancepageno
+ \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
+}
+
+\newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
+
+\def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
+{\catcode`\@ =11
+\gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
+% marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
+\ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
+ \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
+\dimen@=\dp#1 \unvbox#1
+\ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
+\ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
+}
+
+% Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
+% offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
+% (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
+%
+\def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
+\def\nstop{\vbox
+ {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
+\def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
+\def\nsbot{\vbox
+ {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
+
+% Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
+% the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
+% macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
+%
+\def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
+\def\parseargusing#1#2{%
+ \def\next{#2}%
+ \begingroup
+ \obeylines
+ \spaceisspace
+ #1%
+ \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
+}
+
+{\obeylines %
+ \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
+ \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
+ \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
+ }%
+}
+
+% First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
+\def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
+\def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
+
+% Each occurence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
+%
+% \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
+% @end itemize @c foo
+% This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
+% by \finishparsearg.
+%
+\def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
+\def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
+\def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
+ \def\temp{#3}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty
+ % We cannot use \next here, as it holds the macro to run;
+ % thus we reuse \temp.
+ \let\temp\finishparsearg
+ \else
+ \let\temp\argcheckspaces
+ \fi
+ % Put the space token in:
+ \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
+}
+
+% If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
+% to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
+% We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
+% just before passing the control to \next.
+% (Similarily, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
+% either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
+% that a pair of braces would be stripped.
+%
+% But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
+%
+\def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\next\expandafter{#1}}
+
+% \parseargdef\foo{...}
+% is roughly equivalent to
+% \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
+% \def\Xfoo#1{...}
+%
+% Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
+% favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
+
+\def\parseargdef#1{%
+ \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
+}
+\def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
+ \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
+ \def#1##1%
+}
+
+% Several utility definitions with active space:
+{
+ \obeyspaces
+ \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
+
+ % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
+ % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
+ % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
+ % should produce a line of output anyway.
+ %
+ \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
+
+ % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
+ % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
+ % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
+ \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
+}
+
+
+\def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
+
+% Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
+%
+% \envdef\foo{...}
+% \def\Efoo{...}
+%
+% It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
+% actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
+% defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
+% whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
+% used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
+%
+% Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
+% are not treated as enviroments; they don't open a group. (The
+% implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
+% special case.)
+
+
+% At runtime, environments start with this:
+\def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
+% initialize
+\let\thisenv\empty
+
+% ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
+\long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
+\def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
+
+% Check whether we're in the right environment:
+\def\checkenv#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\thisenv\temp
+ \else
+ \badenverr
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Evironment mismatch, #1 expected:
+\def\badenverr{%
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
+ not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
+}
+\def\inenvironment#1{%
+ \ifx#1\empty
+ out of any environment%
+ \else
+ in environment \expandafter\string#1%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
+% But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
+%
+\parseargdef\end{%
+ \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
+ \else
+ % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal, but... --kasal, 06nov03
+ \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
+ \csname E#1\endcsname
+ \endgroup
+ \fi
+}
+
+\newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
+
+
+%% Simple single-character @ commands
+
+% @@ prints an @
+% Kludge this until the fonts are right (grr).
+\def\@{{\tt\char64}}
+
+% This is turned off because it was never documented
+% and you can use @w{...} around a quote to suppress ligatures.
+%% Define @` and @' to be the same as ` and '
+%% but suppressing ligatures.
+%\def\`{{`}}
+%\def\'{{'}}
+
+% Used to generate quoted braces.
+\def\mylbrace {{\tt\char123}}
+\def\myrbrace {{\tt\char125}}
+\let\{=\mylbrace
+\let\}=\myrbrace
+\begingroup
+ % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
+ % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
+ \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
+ \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
+ \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
+ !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
+ !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
+ !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
+ !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
+!endgroup
+
+% @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
+\let\comma = ,
+
+% Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
+% Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
+\let\, = \c
+\let\dotaccent = \.
+\def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
+\let\tieaccent = \t
+\let\ubaraccent = \b
+\let\udotaccent = \d
+
+% Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
+% Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
+\def\questiondown{?`}
+\def\exclamdown{!`}
+\def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
+\def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
+
+% Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
+\def\imacro{i}
+\def\jmacro{j}
+\def\dotless#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\imacro \ptexi
+ \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \j
+ \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
+% period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
+%
+\edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
+
+% @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
+% latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
+% convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
+% the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
+% \scriptscriptstyle).
+%
+\def\LaTeX{%
+ L\kern-.36em
+ {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
+ \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize A}\vss}}%
+ \kern-.15em
+ \TeX
+}
+
+% Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
+% equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
+% at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
+% since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
+% penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
+{\catcode`@ = 11
+ % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
+ % if the definition is written into an index file.
+ \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
+ \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
+}
+
+% @: forces normal size whitespace following.
+\def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
+
+% @* forces a line break.
+\def\*{\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
+
+% @/ allows a line break.
+\let\/=\allowbreak
+
+% @. is an end-of-sentence period.
+\def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
+
+% @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
+\def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
+
+% @? is an end-of-sentence query.
+\def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
+
+% @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
+%
+\def\onword{on}
+\def\offword{off}
+%
+\parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
+ \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on/off}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
+% beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
+% produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
+\def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
+
+% @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
+% it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
+% to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
+% \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
+% max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
+% therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
+% the text is small, which looks bad.
+%
+% Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
+% cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
+% does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
+% explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
+% threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
+% percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
+%
+\newbox\groupbox
+\def\vfilllimit{0.7}
+%
+\envdef\group{%
+ \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
+ \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
+ \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
+ \fi
+ \startsavinginserts
+ %
+ \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
+ % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
+ % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
+ % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
+ % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
+ % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
+ % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
+ \comment
+}
+%
+% The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
+% \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
+% \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
+% above. But it's pretty close.
+\def\Egroup{%
+ % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
+ % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
+ \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
+ \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
+ \egroup % End the \vtop.
+ % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
+ \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
+ % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
+ \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
+ % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
+ % group, force a page break.
+ \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
+ \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
+ \page
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \box\groupbox
+ \prevdepth = \dimen1
+ \checkinserts
+}
+%
+% TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
+% message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
+%
+\newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
+group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
+where each line of input produces a line of output.}
+
+% @need space-in-mils
+% forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
+
+\newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
+
+% Old definition--didn't work.
+%\parseargdef\need{\par %
+%% This method tries to make TeX break the page naturally
+%% if the depth of the box does not fit.
+%{\baselineskip=0pt%
+%\vtop to #1\mil{\vfil}\kern -#1\mil\nobreak
+%\prevdepth=-1000pt
+%}}
+
+\parseargdef\need{%
+ % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
+ % paragraph.
+ \par
+ %
+ % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
+ \dimen0 = #1\mil
+ \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
+ \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
+ \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
+ %
+ % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
+ % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
+ % And a page break here is fine.
+ \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
+ %
+ % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
+ % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
+ % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
+ % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
+ % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
+ %
+ % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
+ % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
+ % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
+ % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
+ % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
+ % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
+ % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
+ \penalty9999
+ %
+ % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
+ \kern -#1\mil
+ %
+ % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
+ \nobreak
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
+
+\let\br = \par
+
+% @page forces the start of a new page.
+%
+\def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
+
+% @exdent text....
+% outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
+
+% This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
+% That's how much \exdent should take out.
+\newskip\exdentamount
+
+% This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
+\parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
+
+% This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
+\parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
+ \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
+
+% @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
+% paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
+% class. WHICH is `l' or `r'.
+%
+\newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
+\def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
+%
+\def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
+ \nobreak
+ \kern-\strutdepth
+ \vtop to \strutdepth{%
+ \baselineskip=\strutdepth
+ \vss
+ % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
+ % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
+ \ifx#1l%
+ \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
+ \else
+ \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
+ \fi
+ \null
+ }%
+}}
+\def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
+\def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
+%
+% @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
+% (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
+% else use TEXT for both).
+%
+\def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
+\def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
+ \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
+ \def\righttext{#2}%
+ \else
+ \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
+ \def\righttext{#1}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifodd\pageno
+ \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
+ \else
+ \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
+ \fi
+ \temp
+}
+
+% @include file insert text of that file as input.
+%
+\def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
+\def\includezzz#1{%
+ \pushthisfilestack
+ \def\thisfile{#1}%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \def\temp{\input #1 }%
+ \expandafter
+ }\temp
+ \popthisfilestack
+}
+\def\filenamecatcodes{%
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+ \catcode`~=\other
+ \catcode`^=\other
+ \catcode`_=\other
+ \catcode`|=\other
+ \catcode`<=\other
+ \catcode`>=\other
+ \catcode`+=\other
+ \catcode`-=\other
+}
+
+\def\pushthisfilestack{%
+ \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
+}
+\def\pushthisfilestackX{%
+ \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
+}
+\def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
+ \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
+}
+
+\def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
+\def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
+ the stack of filenames is empty.}}
+
+\def\thisfile{}
+
+% @center line
+% outputs that line, centered.
+%
+\parseargdef\center{%
+ \ifhmode
+ \let\next\centerH
+ \else
+ \let\next\centerV
+ \fi
+ \next{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
+}
+\def\centerH#1{%
+ {%
+ \hfil\break
+ \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
+ \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+ \line{#1}%
+ \break
+ }%
+}
+\def\centerV#1{\line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}}
+
+% @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
+
+\parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
+
+% @comment ...line which is ignored...
+% @c is the same as @comment
+% @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
+
+\def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
+\catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
+\commentxxx}
+{\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
+
+\let\c=\comment
+
+% @paragraphindent NCHARS
+% We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
+% NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
+% We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
+%
+\def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
+\def\noneword{none}
+%
+\parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\asisword
+ \else
+ \ifx\temp\noneword
+ \defaultparindent = 0pt
+ \else
+ \defaultparindent = #1em
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \parindent = \defaultparindent
+}
+
+% @exampleindent NCHARS
+% We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
+% It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
+% I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
+\parseargdef\exampleindent{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\asisword
+ \else
+ \ifx\temp\noneword
+ \lispnarrowing = 0pt
+ \else
+ \lispnarrowing = #1em
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @firstparagraphindent WORD
+% If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
+% after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
+% paragraphs.
+%
+% The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
+% \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
+% We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
+% By default, we suppress indentation.
+%
+\def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\def\insertword{insert}
+%
+\parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\noneword
+ \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
+ \else\ifx\temp\insertword
+ \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
+% \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
+%
+% We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
+% paragraph.
+%
+\gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
+ \gdef\indent{%
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+ \indent
+ }%
+ \gdef\noindent{%
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+ \noindent
+ }%
+ \global\everypar = {%
+ \kern -\parindent
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+ }%
+}
+
+\gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
+ \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
+ \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
+ \global \everypar = {}%
+}
+
+
+% @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
+%
+\def\asis#1{#1}
+
+% @math outputs its argument in math mode.
+%
+% One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
+% an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
+% _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
+% which is what @var uses.
+{
+ \catcode\underChar = \active
+ \gdef\mathunderscore{%
+ \catcode\underChar=\active
+ \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
+ }
+}
+% Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a \ character.
+% FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (why?), but
+% this is not advertised and we don't care. Texinfo does not
+% otherwise define @\.
+%
+% The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
+\def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
+%
+\def\math{%
+ \tex
+ \mathunderscore
+ \let\\ = \mathbackslash
+ \mathactive
+ $\finishmath
+}
+\def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
+
+% Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
+% We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
+% to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
+%
+{
+ \catcode`^ = \active
+ \catcode`< = \active
+ \catcode`> = \active
+ \catcode`+ = \active
+ \gdef\mathactive{%
+ \let^ = \ptexhat
+ \let< = \ptexless
+ \let> = \ptexgtr
+ \let+ = \ptexplus
+ }
+}
+
+% @bullet and @minus need the same treatment as @math, just above.
+\def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
+\def\minus{$-$}
+
+% @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
+% We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in a typewriter
+% font as three actual period characters.
+%
+\def\dots{%
+ \leavevmode
+ \hbox to 1.5em{%
+ \hskip 0pt plus 0.25fil
+ .\hfil.\hfil.%
+ \hskip 0pt plus 0.5fil
+ }%
+}
+
+% @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
+%
+\def\enddots{%
+ \dots
+ \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
+}
+
+% @comma{} is so commas can be inserted into text without messing up
+% Texinfo's parsing.
+%
+\let\comma = ,
+
+% @refill is a no-op.
+\let\refill=\relax
+
+% If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
+% be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
+% This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
+%
+\newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
+\let\novalidate = \linksfalse
+
+% @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
+% So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
+% This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
+\def\setfilename{%
+ \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
+ \iflinks
+ \tryauxfile
+ % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
+ \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
+ \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
+ \openindices
+ \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
+ %
+ % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
+ % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
+ \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
+ \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
+ \closein 1
+ %
+ \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
+}
+
+% Called from \setfilename.
+%
+\def\openindices{%
+ \newindex{cp}%
+ \newcodeindex{fn}%
+ \newcodeindex{vr}%
+ \newcodeindex{tp}%
+ \newcodeindex{ky}%
+ \newcodeindex{pg}%
+}
+
+% @bye.
+\outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
+
+
+\message{pdf,}
+% adobe `portable' document format
+\newcount\tempnum
+\newcount\lnkcount
+\newtoks\filename
+\newcount\filenamelength
+\newcount\pgn
+\newtoks\toksA
+\newtoks\toksB
+\newtoks\toksC
+\newtoks\toksD
+\newbox\boxA
+\newcount\countA
+\newif\ifpdf
+\newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
+
+% when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
+% can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as \undefined,
+% borrowed from ifpdf.sty.
+\ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
+\else
+ \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
+ \else
+ \ifcase\pdfoutput
+ \else
+ \pdftrue
+ \fi
+ \fi
+\fi
+
+% PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets, to
+% for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
+% double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
+% interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
+% http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html
+% (and related messages, the final outcome is that it is up to the TeX
+% user to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
+% that's we do).
+
+% double active backslashes.
+%
+{\catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active
+ @gdef@activebackslash{@catcode`@\=@active @otherbackslash}
+ @gdef@activebackslashdouble{%
+ @catcode@backChar=@active
+ @let\=@doublebackslash}
+}
+
+% To handle parens, we must adopt a different approach, since parens are
+% not active characters. hyperref.dtx (which has the same problem as
+% us) handles it with this amazing macro to replace tokens. I've
+% tinkered with it a little for texinfo, but it's definitely from there.
+%
+% #1 is the tokens to replace.
+% #2 is the replacement.
+% #3 is the control sequence with the string.
+%
+\def\HyPsdSubst#1#2#3{%
+ \def\HyPsdReplace##1#1##2\END{%
+ ##1%
+ \ifx\\##2\\%
+ \else
+ #2%
+ \HyReturnAfterFi{%
+ \HyPsdReplace##2\END
+ }%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ \xdef#3{\expandafter\HyPsdReplace#3#1\END}%
+}
+\long\def\HyReturnAfterFi#1\fi{\fi#1}
+
+% #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements.
+\def\backslashparens#1{%
+ \xdef#1{#1}% redefine it as its expansion; the definition is simply
+ % \lastnode when called from \setref -> \pdfmkdest.
+ \HyPsdSubst{(}{\backslashlparen}{#1}%
+ \HyPsdSubst{)}{\backslashrparen}{#1}%
+}
+
+{\catcode\exclamChar = 0 \catcode\backChar = \other
+ !gdef!backslashlparen{\(}%
+ !gdef!backslashrparen{\)}%
+}
+
+\ifpdf
+ \input pdfcolor
+ \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}%
+ \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
+ \def\imagewidth{#2}%
+ \def\imageheight{#3}%
+ % without \immediate, pdftex seg faults when the same image is
+ % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
+ \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
+ \immediate\pdfimage
+ \else
+ \immediate\pdfximage
+ \fi
+ \ifx\empty\imagewidth\else width \imagewidth \fi
+ \ifx\empty\imageheight\else height \imageheight \fi
+ \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
+ #1.pdf%
+ \else
+ {#1.pdf}%
+ \fi
+ \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
+ \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
+ \fi}
+ \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
+ % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
+ % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
+ \atdummies
+ \activebackslashdouble
+ \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfdestname
+ \pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz%
+ }}%
+ %
+ % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
+ \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}%
+ %
+ \let\linkcolor = \Blue % was Cyan, but that seems light?
+ \def\endlink{\Black\pdfendlink}
+ % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
+ % come from Petr Olsak
+ \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
+ \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
+ \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
+ \advance\tempnum by 1
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
+ %
+ % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
+ % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
+ % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
+ % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
+ % #4 is the page number
+ %
+ \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
+ % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
+ % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
+ % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
+ % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
+ \def\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
+ \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
+ \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
+ \else
+ % Doubled backslashes in the name.
+ {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfoutlinedest}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Also double the backslashes in the display string.
+ {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfoutlinetext}%
+ %
+ \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
+ }
+ %
+ \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
+ \begingroup
+ % Thanh's hack / proper braces in bookmarks
+ \edef\mylbrace{\iftrue \string{\else}\fi}\let\{=\mylbrace
+ \edef\myrbrace{\iffalse{\else\string}\fi}\let\}=\myrbrace
+ %
+ % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
+ \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \def\thischapnum{##2}%
+ \def\thissecnum{0}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+ }%
+ \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
+ \def\thissecnum{##2}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+ }%
+ \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
+ }%
+ \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
+ }%
+ \def\thischapnum{0}%
+ \def\thissecnum{0}%
+ \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
+ %
+ % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
+ % al. a second time, below.
+ \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
+ \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
+ \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
+ \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
+ \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
+ \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
+ \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
+ \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
+ \readdatafile{toc}%
+ %
+ % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
+ % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
+ % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
+ %
+ % We use the node names as the destinations.
+ \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
+ \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
+ \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
+ \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
+ \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
+ %
+ % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
+ % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
+ % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
+ % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
+ % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
+ %
+ % xx to do this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
+ % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Right
+ % now, I guess we'll just let the pdf reader have its way.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \setupdatafile
+ \activebackslash
+ \input \jobname.toc
+ \endgroup
+ }
+ %
+ \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
+ \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
+ \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
+ \ifx\p\space\else\addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
+ \advance\filenamelength by 1
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \nextsp}
+ \def\getfilename#1{\filenamelength=0\expandafter\skipspaces#1|\relax}
+ \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
+ \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
+ \else
+ \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
+ \fi
+ \def\pdfurl#1{%
+ \begingroup
+ \normalturnoffactive\def\@{@}%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \leavevmode\Red
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
+ user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
+ \endgroup}
+ \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
+ \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
+ \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
+ \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
+ \def\maketoks{%
+ \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
+ \ifx\first0\adn0
+ \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
+ \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
+ \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
+ \else
+ \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
+ \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
+ \let\next=\maketoks
+ \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
+ \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
+ \fi
+ \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
+ \next}
+ \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
+ {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
+ \def\pdflink#1{%
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
+ \linkcolor #1\endlink}
+ \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
+\else
+ \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
+ \let\pdfurl = \gobble
+ \let\endlink = \relax
+ \let\linkcolor = \relax
+ \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
+\fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
+
+
+\message{fonts,}
+
+% Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
+% For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
+% italics, not bold italics.
+%
+\def\setfontstyle#1{%
+ \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
+ \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
+}
+
+% Select #1 fonts with the current style.
+%
+\def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
+
+\def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
+\def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
+\def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
+\def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
+\def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
+
+% Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
+% So we set up a \sf.
+\newfam\sffam
+\def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
+\let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
+
+% We don't need math for this font style.
+\def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
+
+% Default leading.
+\newdimen\textleading \textleading = 13.2pt
+
+% Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
+% correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
+% used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
+%
+\def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
+\def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
+\def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
+%
+\def\setleading#1{%
+ \normalbaselineskip = #1\relax
+ \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
+ \normalbaselines
+ \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
+ \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
+ depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
+ }%
+}
+
+% Set the font macro #1 to the font named #2, adding on the
+% specified font prefix (normally `cm').
+% #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor
+\def\setfont#1#2#3#4{\font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4}
+
+% Use cm as the default font prefix.
+% To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
+% before you read in texinfo.tex.
+\ifx\fontprefix\undefined
+\def\fontprefix{cm}
+\fi
+% Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
+\def\rmshape{r}
+\def\rmbshape{bx} %where the normal face is bold
+\def\bfshape{b}
+\def\bxshape{bx}
+\def\ttshape{tt}
+\def\ttbshape{tt}
+\def\ttslshape{sltt}
+\def\itshape{ti}
+\def\itbshape{bxti}
+\def\slshape{sl}
+\def\slbshape{bxsl}
+\def\sfshape{ss}
+\def\sfbshape{ss}
+\def\scshape{csc}
+\def\scbshape{csc}
+
+% Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
+\def\textnominalsize{11pt}
+\edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}
+\font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
+\font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
+
+% A few fonts for @defun names and args.
+\setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}
+\def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
+
+% Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
+\def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
+\setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}
+\setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}
+\setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}
+\font\smalli=cmmi9
+\font\smallsy=cmsy9
+
+% Fonts for small examples (8pt).
+\def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
+\setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}
+\setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}
+\setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}
+\setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}
+\font\smalleri=cmmi8
+\font\smallersy=cmsy8
+
+% Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
+\def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
+\setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}
+\let\titlebf=\titlerm
+\setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}
+\font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
+\font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
+\def\authorrm{\secrm}
+\def\authortt{\sectt}
+
+% Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
+\def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
+\setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}
+\let\chapbf=\chaprm
+\setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}
+\font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
+\font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
+
+% Section fonts (14.4pt).
+\def\secnominalsize{14pt}
+\setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}
+\let\secbf\secrm
+\setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}
+\font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
+\font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
+
+% Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
+\def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
+\setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}
+\setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}
+\let\ssecbf\ssecrm
+\setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}
+\font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
+\font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
+
+% Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
+\def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
+\setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}
+\setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}
+\font\reducedi=cmmi10
+\font\reducedsy=cmsy10
+
+% In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
+% we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
+% texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
+% in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
+% \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
+%
+\def\resetmathfonts{%
+ \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
+ \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
+ \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
+}
+
+% The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
+% of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
+% current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
+% \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
+%
+% Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
+% and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
+% the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
+%
+% This all needs generalizing, badly.
+%
+\def\textfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
+ \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
+ \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{text}%
+ \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
+\def\titlefonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
+ \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
+ \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
+ \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
+ \def\curfontsize{title}%
+ \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{25pt}}
+\def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rm #1}}
+\def\chapfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
+ \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
+ \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{chap}%
+ \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
+\def\secfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
+ \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
+ \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{sec}%
+ \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
+\def\subsecfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
+ \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
+ \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
+ \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
+\let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
+\def\reducedfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
+ \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
+ \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
+ \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
+\def\smallfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
+ \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
+ \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
+ \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{small}%
+ \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
+\def\smallerfonts{%
+ \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
+ \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
+ \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
+ \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
+ \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
+ \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
+ \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
+
+% Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
+\let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
+
+% About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
+% can fit this many characters:
+% 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
+% If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
+% 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
+% For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
+% the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
+%
+% By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
+% 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
+%
+% I wish the USA used A4 paper.
+% --karl, 24jan03.
+
+
+% Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
+%
+\textfonts \rm
+
+% Define these so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
+\def\angleleft{$\langle$}
+\def\angleright{$\rangle$}
+
+% Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
+\newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
+
+% Fonts for short table of contents.
+\setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1} % no cmb12
+\setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}
+\setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}
+
+%% Add scribe-like font environments, plus @l for inline lisp (usually sans
+%% serif) and @ii for TeX italic
+
+% \smartitalic{ARG} outputs arg in italics, followed by an italic correction
+% unless the following character is such as not to need one.
+\def\smartitalicx{\ifx\next,\else\ifx\next-\else\ifx\next.\else
+ \ptexslash\fi\fi\fi}
+\def\smartslanted#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+\def\smartitalic#1{{\ifusingtt\ttsl\it #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+
+% like \smartslanted except unconditionally uses \ttsl.
+% @var is set to this for defun arguments.
+\def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+
+% like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
+% ttsl for book titles, do we?
+\def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitalicx}
+
+\let\i=\smartitalic
+\let\slanted=\smartslanted
+\let\var=\smartslanted
+\let\dfn=\smartslanted
+\let\emph=\smartitalic
+
+% @b, explicit bold.
+\def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
+\let\strong=\b
+
+% @sansserif, explicit sans.
+\def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
+
+% We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
+% the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
+% group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
+%
+\def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
+\def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
+
+% Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
+% Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
+% sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
+%
+\catcode`@=11
+ \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
+ \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
+ \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
+ \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
+ }
+ \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
+ \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
+ \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
+ \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
+ }
+\catcode`@=\other
+\def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
+
+\def\t#1{%
+ {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
+ \null
+}
+\def\samp#1{`\tclose{#1}'\null}
+\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}
+\font\keysy=cmsy9
+\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
+ \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
+ \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
+ \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
+ \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
+ \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
+% The old definition, with no lozenge:
+%\def\key #1{{\ttsl \nohyphenation \uppercase{#1}}\null}
+\def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
+
+% @file, @option are the same as @samp.
+\let\file=\samp
+\let\option=\samp
+
+% @code is a modification of @t,
+% which makes spaces the same size as normal in the surrounding text.
+\def\tclose#1{%
+ {%
+ % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
+ \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
+ %
+ % Switch to typewriter.
+ \tt
+ %
+ % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
+ \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
+ %
+ % Turn off hyphenation.
+ \nohyphenation
+ %
+ \rawbackslash
+ \plainfrenchspacing
+ #1%
+ }%
+ \null
+}
+
+% We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
+% Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
+% in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
+
+% Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
+% both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
+% We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
+% and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash.
+% -- rms.
+{
+ \catcode`\-=\active
+ \catcode`\_=\active
+ %
+ \global\def\code{\begingroup
+ \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
+ \ifallowcodebreaks
+ \let-\codedash
+ \let_\codeunder
+ \else
+ \let-\realdash
+ \let_\realunder
+ \fi
+ \codex
+ }
+}
+
+\def\realdash{-}
+\def\codedash{-\discretionary{}{}{}}
+\def\codeunder{%
+ % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
+ % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
+ % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
+ % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
+ \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
+ \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
+ \else\normalunderscore \fi
+ \discretionary{}{}{}}%
+ {\_}%
+}
+\def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
+
+% An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
+% each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is undesirable in
+% some manuals, especially if they don't have long identifiers in
+% general. @allowcodebreaks provides a way to control this.
+%
+\newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
+
+\def\keywordtrue{true}
+\def\keywordfalse{false}
+
+\parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
+ \def\txiarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
+ \allowcodebreakstrue
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
+ \allowcodebreaksfalse
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg'}%
+ \fi\fi
+}
+
+% @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
+% then @kbd has no effect.
+
+% @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
+% `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
+% or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
+\parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
+ \def\txiarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
+ \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
+ \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
+ \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
+ \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
+ \else
+ \errhelp = \EMsimple
+ \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle option `\txiarg'}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
+\def\worddistinct{distinct}
+\def\wordexample{example}
+\def\wordcode{code}
+
+% Default is `distinct.'
+\kbdinputstyle distinct
+
+\def\xkey{\key}
+\def\kbdfoo#1#2#3\par{\def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
+\ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
+\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi
+\else{\tclose{\kbdfont\look}}\fi}
+
+% For @indicateurl, @env, @command quotes seem unnecessary, so use \code.
+\let\indicateurl=\code
+\let\env=\code
+\let\command=\code
+
+% @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') takes an optional (comma-separated)
+% second argument specifying the text to display and an optional third
+% arg as text to display instead of (rather than in addition to) the url
+% itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. Perhaps eventually put in
+% a hypertex \special here.
+%
+\def\uref#1{\douref #1,,,\finish}
+\def\douref#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{\begingroup
+ \unsepspaces
+ \pdfurl{#1}%
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
+ \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
+ \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
+ \else
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
+ \ifpdf
+ \unhbox0 % PDF: 2nd arg given, show only it
+ \else
+ \unhbox0\ (\code{#1})% DVI: 2nd arg given, show both it and url
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \code{#1}% only url given, so show it
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \endlink
+\endgroup}
+
+% @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
+%
+\let\url=\uref
+
+% rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
+% So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
+%
+%\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
+\ifpdf
+ \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
+ \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
+ \unsepspaces
+ \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
+ \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
+ \endlink
+ \endgroup}
+\else
+ \let\email=\uref
+\fi
+
+% Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
+% Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
+% shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
+% this property, we can check that font parameter.
+%
+\def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
+
+% Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
+% argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
+%
+\def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
+
+\def\kbd#1{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdfoo\look??\par}
+
+% @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
+% and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
+% Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
+%\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
+
+% Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
+\def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
+\def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
+\def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
+
+% @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
+% We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
+% all-uppercase.
+%
+\def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
+\def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
+ {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \else
+ \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
+% No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
+%
+\def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
+\def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
+ {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \else
+ \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
+%
+\def\pounds{{\it\$}}
+
+% @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
+% We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
+% Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
+% "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
+% It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
+%
+% Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
+% that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
+% font height.
+%
+% feymr - regular
+% feymo - slanted
+% feybr - bold
+% feybo - bold slanted
+%
+% There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
+% A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
+% Hmm.
+%
+% Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
+% Hope not.
+%
+%
+\def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
+\def\eurofont{%
+ % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
+ % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
+ % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
+ % font installed.
+ %
+ % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
+ % that to the current nominal size.
+ %
+ % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
+ % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
+ %
+ \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
+ %
+ \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
+ % bold:
+ \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
+ \else
+ % regular:
+ \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
+ \fi
+ \thiseurofont
+}
+
+% @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
+% be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
+% Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
+%
+\def\registeredsymbol{%
+ $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
+ \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
+ }$%
+}
+
+% Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
+% Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
+% so we'll define it if necessary.
+%
+\ifx\Orb\undefined
+\def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
+\fi
+
+
+\message{page headings,}
+
+\newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
+\newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
+
+% First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
+\newif\ifseenauthor
+\newif\iffinishedtitlepage
+
+% Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
+% user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
+%
+\newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
+ \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
+\newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
+ \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
+
+\parseargdef\shorttitlepage{\begingroup\hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
+ \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
+
+\envdef\titlepage{%
+ % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
+ \begingroup
+ \parindent=0pt \textfonts
+ % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
+ \vglue\titlepagetopglue
+ % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
+ \finishedtitlepagetrue
+ %
+ % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
+ % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
+ \let\oldpage = \page
+ \def\page{%
+ \iffinishedtitlepage\else
+ \finishtitlepage
+ \fi
+ \let\page = \oldpage
+ \page
+ \null
+ }%
+}
+
+\def\Etitlepage{%
+ \iffinishedtitlepage\else
+ \finishtitlepage
+ \fi
+ % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
+ % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
+ % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
+ % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
+ \oldpage
+ \endgroup
+ %
+ % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
+ % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
+ \HEADINGSon
+ %
+ % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
+ \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
+ \shortcontents
+ \contents
+ \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
+ \global\let\contents = \relax
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
+ \contents
+ \global\let\contents = \relax
+ \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
+ \fi
+}
+
+\def\finishtitlepage{%
+ \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
+ \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
+ \finishedtitlepagetrue
+}
+
+%%% Macros to be used within @titlepage:
+
+\let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
+\def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
+
+\def\authorfont{\authorrm \normalbaselineskip = 16pt \normalbaselines
+ \let\tt=\authortt}
+
+\parseargdef\title{%
+ \checkenv\titlepage
+ \leftline{\titlefonts\rm #1}
+ % print a rule at the page bottom also.
+ \finishedtitlepagefalse
+ \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
+}
+
+\parseargdef\subtitle{%
+ \checkenv\titlepage
+ {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
+}
+
+% @author should come last, but may come many times.
+% It can also be used inside @quotation.
+%
+\parseargdef\author{%
+ \def\temp{\quotation}%
+ \ifx\thisenv\temp
+ \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
+ \else
+ \checkenv\titlepage
+ \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
+ {\authorfont \leftline{#1}}%
+ \fi
+}
+
+
+%%% Set up page headings and footings.
+
+\let\thispage=\folio
+
+\newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
+\newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
+\newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
+\newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
+
+% Now make TeX use those variables
+\headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
+ \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
+\footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
+ \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
+\let\HEADINGShook=\relax
+
+% Commands to set those variables.
+% For example, this is what @headings on does
+% @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
+% @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
+% @evenfooting @thisfile||
+% @oddfooting ||@thisfile
+
+
+\def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
+\def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
+\def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
+
+\def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
+\def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+\global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
+
+\def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
+\def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
+\def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
+ \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
+ %
+ % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
+ % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
+ \global\advance\pageheight by -\baselineskip
+ \global\advance\vsize by -\baselineskip
+}
+
+\parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
+
+
+% @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
+% @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
+% @headings off turns them off.
+% @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
+% @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
+% @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
+% @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
+% By default, they are off at the start of a document,
+% and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
+
+\def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
+
+\def\HEADINGSoff{%
+\global\evenheadline={\hfil} \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddheadline={\hfil} \global\oddfootline={\hfil}}
+\HEADINGSoff
+% When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
+% For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
+% chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
+% title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
+% edge of all pages.
+\def\HEADINGSdouble{%
+\global\pageno=1
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
+}
+\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
+
+% For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
+% page number on top right.
+\def\HEADINGSsingle{%
+\global\pageno=1
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
+}
+\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
+
+\def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
+\let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
+\def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
+}
+
+\def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
+\def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
+\global\evenfootline={\hfil}
+\global\oddfootline={\hfil}
+\global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
+}
+
+% Subroutines used in generating headings
+% This produces Day Month Year style of output.
+% Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
+% up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
+\ifx\today\undefined
+\def\today{%
+ \number\day\space
+ \ifcase\month
+ \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
+ \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
+ \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
+ \fi
+ \space\number\year}
+\fi
+
+% @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
+% It generates no output of its own.
+\def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
+\def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
+
+
+\message{tables,}
+% Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
+
+% default indentation of table text
+\newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
+% default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
+\newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
+% margin between end of table item and start of table text.
+\newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
+
+% used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
+\newdimen\itemmax
+
+% Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
+% these defs.
+% They also define \itemindex
+% to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
+
+\newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
+
+\def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
+
+\def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
+\def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
+
+\def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
+ \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
+ \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
+ \itemindex{#1}%
+ \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
+ %
+ % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
+ % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
+ % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
+ % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
+ % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
+ \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
+ %
+ % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
+ % but leave it ragged-right.
+ \begingroup
+ \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
+ \advance\hsize by\tableindent
+ \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil
+ \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
+ \endgroup
+ %
+ % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
+ % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
+ \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
+ %
+ % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
+ % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
+ % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
+ % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
+ % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
+ % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
+ %
+ \penalty 10001
+ \endgroup
+ \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
+ \else
+ % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
+ % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
+ \noindent
+ % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
+ % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
+ % eventually be printed.
+ \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
+ \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
+ \unhbox0
+ \nobreak\kern\dimen0
+ \endgroup
+ \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
+ \fi
+}
+
+\def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
+\def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
+
+% @table, @ftable, @vtable.
+\envdef\table{%
+ \let\itemindex\gobble
+ \tablecheck{table}%
+}
+\envdef\ftable{%
+ \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
+ \tablecheck{ftable}%
+}
+\envdef\vtable{%
+ \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
+ \tablecheck{vtable}%
+}
+\def\tablecheck#1{%
+ \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
+ \endgroup
+ \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
+ that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
+ \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
+ \else
+ \let\next\tablex
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+\def\tablex#1{%
+ \def\itemindicate{#1}%
+ \parsearg\tabley
+}
+\def\tabley#1{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
+ \expandafter
+ }\temp \endtablez
+}
+\def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
+ \aboveenvbreak
+ \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
+ \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
+ \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
+ \itemmax=\tableindent
+ \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
+ \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
+ \exdentamount=\tableindent
+ \parindent = 0pt
+ \parskip = \smallskipamount
+ \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
+ \let\item = \internalBitem
+ \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
+}
+\def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
+\let\Eftable\Etable
+\let\Evtable\Etable
+\let\Eitemize\Etable
+\let\Eenumerate\Etable
+
+% This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
+
+\newcount \itemno
+
+\envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
+
+\def\doitemize#1{%
+ \aboveenvbreak
+ \itemmax=\itemindent
+ \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
+ \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
+ \exdentamount=\itemindent
+ \parindent=0pt
+ \parskip=\smallskipamount
+ \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
+ \def\itemcontents{#1}%
+ % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
+ \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
+ \let\item=\itemizeitem
+}
+
+% Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
+%
+\def\itemizeitem{%
+ \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
+ {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
+ {%
+ % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
+ % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
+ % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
+ % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
+ % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
+ % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
+ % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
+ % that's the theory.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
+ \noindent
+ \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
+ \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
+ \flushcr
+}
+
+% \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
+% TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
+%
+\def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
+
+% Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
+% or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
+% argument is the same as `1'.
+%
+\envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
+\def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
+ % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
+ \def\thearg{#1}%
+ \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
+ %
+ % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
+ % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
+ % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
+ % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
+ % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
+ \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
+ \ifx\rest\empty
+ % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
+ % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
+ % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
+ % not equal to itself.
+ % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
+ %
+ % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
+ % continuing to look for a <number>.
+ %
+ \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
+ \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
+ \else
+ % It's a letter.
+ \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
+ \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
+ \else
+ \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
+ \numericenumerate
+ \fi
+}
+
+% An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
+% given in \thearg.
+%
+\def\numericenumerate{%
+ \itemno = \thearg
+ \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
+}
+
+% The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
+\def\lowercaseenumerate{%
+ \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
+ \startenumeration{%
+ % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
+ \ifnum\itemno=0
+ \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
+ alphabet}%
+ \fi
+ \char\lccode\itemno
+ }%
+}
+
+% The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
+\def\uppercaseenumerate{%
+ \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
+ \startenumeration{%
+ % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
+ \ifnum\itemno=0
+ \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
+ alphabet}
+ \fi
+ \char\uccode\itemno
+ }%
+}
+
+% Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
+% common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
+% \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
+%
+\def\startenumeration#1{%
+ \advance\itemno by -1
+ \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
+}
+
+% @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
+% to @enumerate.
+%
+\def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
+\def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
+\def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
+\def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
+
+
+% @multitable macros
+% Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
+%
+% @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
+% Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
+% can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
+% or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
+
+% Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
+
+% To make preamble:
+%
+% Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
+% @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
+% @item ...
+%
+% Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
+% current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
+% columns as desired.
+
+
+% Or use a template:
+% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
+% @item ...
+% using the widest term desired in each column.
+
+% Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
+% starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
+% with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
+% ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
+
+% @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
+% if they are.
+
+% Sample multitable:
+
+% @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
+% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
+% @item
+% first col stuff
+% @tab
+% second col stuff
+% @tab
+% third col
+% @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
+% @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
+%
+% They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
+% @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
+% @end multitable
+
+% Default dimensions may be reset by user.
+% @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
+% @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
+% @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
+% @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
+% to baseline.
+% 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
+%
+\newskip\multitableparskip
+\newskip\multitableparindent
+\newdimen\multitablecolspace
+\newskip\multitablelinespace
+\multitableparskip=0pt
+\multitableparindent=6pt
+\multitablecolspace=12pt
+\multitablelinespace=0pt
+
+% Macros used to set up halign preamble:
+%
+\let\endsetuptable\relax
+\def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
+\let\columnfractions\relax
+\def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
+\newif\ifsetpercent
+
+% #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
+% be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
+%
+\def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
+ \global\advance\colcount by 1
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
+ \setuptable
+}
+
+\newcount\colcount
+\def\setuptable#1{%
+ \def\firstarg{#1}%
+ \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
+ \let\go = \relax
+ \else
+ \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
+ \global\setpercenttrue
+ \else
+ \ifsetpercent
+ \let\go\pickupwholefraction
+ \else
+ \global\advance\colcount by 1
+ \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
+ % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
+ % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
+ % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
+ \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
+ \else
+ \let\go = \setuptable
+ \fi%
+ \fi
+ \go
+}
+
+% multitable-only commands.
+%
+% @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
+% Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
+% of an alignment entry. Note that \everycr resets \everytab.
+\def\headitem{\checkenv\multitable \crcr \global\everytab={\bf}\the\everytab}%
+%
+% A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
+% line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
+% we encounter the problem it was intended to solve again.
+% --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
+\def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
+
+% @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
+%
+\newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
+%
+\envdef\multitable{%
+ \vskip\parskip
+ \startsavinginserts
+ %
+ % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
+ % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
+ % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
+ % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
+ \def\item{\crcr}%
+ %
+ \tolerance=9500
+ \hbadness=9500
+ \setmultitablespacing
+ \parskip=\multitableparskip
+ \parindent=\multitableparindent
+ \overfullrule=0pt
+ \global\colcount=0
+ %
+ \everycr = {%
+ \noalign{%
+ \global\everytab={}%
+ \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
+ % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
+ \checkinserts
+ % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
+ %\filbreak
+ % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
+ % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
+ % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
+ }%
+ }%
+ %
+ \parsearg\domultitable
+}
+\def\domultitable#1{%
+ % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
+ \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
+ %
+ % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
+ % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
+ % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
+ % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
+ \halign\bgroup &%
+ \global\advance\colcount by 1
+ \multistrut
+ \vtop{%
+ % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
+ \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
+ %
+ % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
+ % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
+ % the first one.
+ %
+ % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
+ % to the width of each template entry.
+ %
+ % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
+ % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
+ % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
+ % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
+ %
+ % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
+ \rightskip=0pt
+ \ifnum\colcount=1
+ % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
+ \advance\hsize by\leftskip
+ \else
+ \ifsetpercent \else
+ % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
+ % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
+ \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
+ \fi
+ % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
+ \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
+ \fi
+ % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
+ % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
+ % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
+ % For example:
+ % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
+ % @item @code{#}
+ % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
+ % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
+ % marking characters.
+ \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
+ }\cr
+}
+\def\Emultitable{%
+ \crcr
+ \egroup % end the \halign
+ \global\setpercentfalse
+}
+
+\def\setmultitablespacing{%
+ \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
+ %
+ % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
+ % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
+ % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
+ % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
+\ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
+\setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
+\global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
+\fi
+%% Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
+%% table. If not, do nothing.
+%% If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
+\ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
+\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
+\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
+ %% than skip between lines in the table.
+\fi%
+\ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
+\global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
+\global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt %% to keep parskip somewhat smaller
+ %% than skip between lines in the table.
+\fi}
+
+
+\message{conditionals,}
+
+% @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
+% @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
+% attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
+% have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
+% attempt to close an environment group.
+%
+\def\makecond#1{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
+ \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
+}
+\makecond{iftex}
+\makecond{ifnotdocbook}
+\makecond{ifnothtml}
+\makecond{ifnotinfo}
+\makecond{ifnotplaintext}
+\makecond{ifnotxml}
+
+% Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
+%
+\def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
+\def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
+\def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
+\def\html{\doignore{html}}
+\def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
+\def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
+\def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
+\def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
+\def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
+\def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
+\def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
+\def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
+\def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
+
+% Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
+%
+% A count to remember the depth of nesting.
+\newcount\doignorecount
+
+\def\doignore#1{\begingroup
+ % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
+ \catcode`\@ = \other
+ \catcode`\{ = \other
+ \catcode`\} = \other
+ %
+ % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
+ \spaceisspace
+ %
+ % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
+ \doignorecount = 0
+ %
+ % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
+ \dodoignore{#1}%
+}
+
+{ \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
+ \obeylines %
+ %
+ \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
+ % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
+ %
+ % Define a command to find the next `@end #1', which must be on a line
+ % by itself.
+ \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
+ % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
+ % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
+ % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
+ \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
+ %
+ % And now expand that command.
+ \obeylines %
+ \doignoretext ^^M%
+ }%
+}
+
+\def\doignoreyyy#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
+ \let\next\doignoretextzzz
+ \else % Found a nested condition, ...
+ \advance\doignorecount by 1
+ \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
+ % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
+ \fi
+ \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
+}
+
+% We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
+%
+\def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
+ \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
+ \let\next\enddoignore
+ \else % Still inside a nested condition.
+ \advance\doignorecount by -1
+ \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
+ \fi
+ \next
+}
+
+% Finish off ignored text.
+\def\enddoignore{\endgroup\ignorespaces}
+
+
+% @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
+% @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
+%
+% Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
+% empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
+% own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
+% didn't need it.
+% We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
+%
+\parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
+\def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \def\temp{#2}%
+ \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty
+ \next{}%
+ \else
+ \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
+ \fi
+ }%
+}
+% Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
+\def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
+
+% @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
+%
+\parseargdef\clear{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
+ }%
+}
+
+% @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
+\def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
+\def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
+{
+ \catcode`\- = \active \catcode`\_ = \active
+ %
+ \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
+ \let\value = \expandablevalue
+ % We don't want these characters active, ...
+ \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
+ % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
+ % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
+ % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
+ \let-\realdash \let_\normalunderscore
+ }
+}
+
+% We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
+% properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
+% The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
+% the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
+% variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
+% it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
+% to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
+%
+\def\expandablevalue#1{%
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
+ {[No value for ``#1'']}%
+ \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
+ \else
+ \csname SET#1\endcsname
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
+% with @set.
+%
+% To get special treatment of `@end ifset,' call \makeond and the redefine.
+%
+\makecond{ifset}
+\def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
+\def\doifset#1#2{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \let\next=\empty
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
+ #1% If not set, redefine \next.
+ \fi
+ \expandafter
+ }\next
+}
+\def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
+
+% @ifclear VAR ... @end ifclear reads the `...' iff VAR has never been
+% defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
+%
+% The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
+% above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
+% then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
+%
+\makecond{ifclear}
+\def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
+\def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
+
+% @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
+% which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
+\let\dircategory=\comment
+
+% @defininfoenclose.
+\let\definfoenclose=\comment
+
+
+\message{indexing,}
+% Index generation facilities
+
+% Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
+% except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
+\edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
+
+% \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
+% It automatically defines \fooindex such that
+% \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
+% It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
+% the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
+% The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
+% for the sake of vms.
+%
+\def\newindex#1{%
+ \iflinks
+ \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
+ \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
+ \fi
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
+ \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
+}
+
+% @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
+%
+\def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
+
+% Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
+%
+\def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
+%
+\def\newcodeindex#1{%
+ \iflinks
+ \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
+ \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
+ \fi
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
+}
+
+
+% @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
+% Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
+%
+% @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
+% inside @code.
+%
+\def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
+\def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
+
+% #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
+% #3 the target index (bar).
+\def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
+ % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
+ % closing the target index.
+ \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \undefined
+ % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
+ % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
+ \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
+ \expandafter\let\csname\donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
+ \fi
+ % redefine \fooindfile:
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
+ \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
+ % redefine \fooindex:
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
+}
+
+% Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
+% Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
+% and it is "foo", the name of the index.
+
+% \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
+% This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
+
+% There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
+% which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
+
+\def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
+\def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
+
+% like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
+\def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
+\def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
+
+% Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
+% Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
+% we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
+%
+\def\indexdummies{%
+ \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
+ \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
+ \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
+ % Need these in case \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
+ % But can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
+ % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters.
+ \let\{ = \mylbrace
+ \let\} = \myrbrace
+ %
+ % Do the redefinitions.
+ \commondummies
+}
+
+% For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
+% redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
+% \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
+% this will be simpler.
+%
+\def\atdummies{%
+ \def\@{@@}%
+ \def\ {@ }%
+ \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
+ \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
+ %
+ % Do the redefinitions.
+ \commondummies
+}
+
+% Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
+%
+\def\commondummies{%
+ %
+ % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
+ % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control% words,
+ % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
+ % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
+ % from whatever follows.
+ %
+ % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
+ % space.
+ %
+ % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
+ % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
+ % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
+ %
+ \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
+ \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
+ \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
+ %
+ \commondummiesnofonts
+ %
+ \definedummyletter\_%
+ %
+ % Non-English letters.
+ \definedummyword\AA
+ \definedummyword\AE
+ \definedummyword\L
+ \definedummyword\OE
+ \definedummyword\O
+ \definedummyword\aa
+ \definedummyword\ae
+ \definedummyword\l
+ \definedummyword\oe
+ \definedummyword\o
+ \definedummyword\ss
+ \definedummyword\exclamdown
+ \definedummyword\questiondown
+ \definedummyword\ordf
+ \definedummyword\ordm
+ %
+ % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
+ \definedummyword\bf
+ \definedummyword\gtr
+ \definedummyword\hat
+ \definedummyword\less
+ \definedummyword\sf
+ \definedummyword\sl
+ \definedummyword\tclose
+ \definedummyword\tt
+ %
+ \definedummyword\LaTeX
+ \definedummyword\TeX
+ %
+ % Assorted special characters.
+ \definedummyword\bullet
+ \definedummyword\comma
+ \definedummyword\copyright
+ \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
+ \definedummyword\dots
+ \definedummyword\enddots
+ \definedummyword\equiv
+ \definedummyword\error
+ \definedummyword\euro
+ \definedummyword\expansion
+ \definedummyword\minus
+ \definedummyword\pounds
+ \definedummyword\point
+ \definedummyword\print
+ \definedummyword\result
+ %
+ % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
+ \macrolist
+ %
+ \normalturnoffactive
+ %
+ % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
+ % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
+ \makevalueexpandable
+}
+
+% \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
+%
+% Better have this without active chars.
+{
+ \catcode`\~=\other
+ \gdef\commondummiesnofonts{%
+ % Control letters and accents.
+ \definedummyletter\!%
+ \definedummyaccent\"%
+ \definedummyaccent\'%
+ \definedummyletter\*%
+ \definedummyaccent\,%
+ \definedummyletter\.%
+ \definedummyletter\/%
+ \definedummyletter\:%
+ \definedummyaccent\=%
+ \definedummyletter\?%
+ \definedummyaccent\^%
+ \definedummyaccent\`%
+ \definedummyaccent\~%
+ \definedummyword\u
+ \definedummyword\v
+ \definedummyword\H
+ \definedummyword\dotaccent
+ \definedummyword\ringaccent
+ \definedummyword\tieaccent
+ \definedummyword\ubaraccent
+ \definedummyword\udotaccent
+ \definedummyword\dotless
+ %
+ % Texinfo font commands.
+ \definedummyword\b
+ \definedummyword\i
+ \definedummyword\r
+ \definedummyword\sc
+ \definedummyword\t
+ %
+ % Commands that take arguments.
+ \definedummyword\acronym
+ \definedummyword\cite
+ \definedummyword\code
+ \definedummyword\command
+ \definedummyword\dfn
+ \definedummyword\emph
+ \definedummyword\env
+ \definedummyword\file
+ \definedummyword\kbd
+ \definedummyword\key
+ \definedummyword\math
+ \definedummyword\option
+ \definedummyword\samp
+ \definedummyword\strong
+ \definedummyword\tie
+ \definedummyword\uref
+ \definedummyword\url
+ \definedummyword\var
+ \definedummyword\verb
+ \definedummyword\w
+ }
+}
+
+% \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
+% by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
+% control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
+% would be for a given command (usually its argument).
+%
+\def\indexnofonts{%
+ % Accent commands should become @asis.
+ \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
+ % We can just ignore other control letters.
+ \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
+ % Hopefully, all control words can become @asis.
+ \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
+ %
+ \commondummiesnofonts
+ %
+ % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
+ % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
+ % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
+ %\let\tt=\asis
+ %
+ \def\ { }%
+ \def\@{@}%
+ % how to handle braces?
+ \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
+ %
+ % Non-English letters.
+ \def\AA{AA}%
+ \def\AE{AE}%
+ \def\L{L}%
+ \def\OE{OE}%
+ \def\O{O}%
+ \def\aa{aa}%
+ \def\ae{ae}%
+ \def\l{l}%
+ \def\oe{oe}%
+ \def\o{o}%
+ \def\ss{ss}%
+ \def\exclamdown{!}%
+ \def\questiondown{?}%
+ \def\ordf{a}%
+ \def\ordm{o}%
+ %
+ \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
+ \def\TeX{TeX}%
+ %
+ % Assorted special characters.
+ % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
+ \def\bullet{bullet}%
+ \def\comma{,}%
+ \def\copyright{copyright}%
+ \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
+ \def\dots{...}%
+ \def\enddots{...}%
+ \def\equiv{==}%
+ \def\error{error}%
+ \def\euro{euro}%
+ \def\expansion{==>}%
+ \def\minus{-}%
+ \def\pounds{pounds}%
+ \def\point{.}%
+ \def\print{-|}%
+ \def\result{=>}%
+ %
+ % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
+ % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
+ % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
+ % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
+ % that starts with \.
+ %
+ % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
+ % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
+ % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
+ %
+ \macrolist
+}
+
+\let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
+\let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
+
+% Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
+% #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
+\def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
+
+% Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
+% #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
+% empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
+% is with most defuns, which call us directly).
+%
+\def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
+ \iflinks
+ {%
+ % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
+ \toks0 = {#2}%
+ % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
+ \def\thirdarg{#3}%
+ \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
+ %
+ \ifvmode
+ \dosubindsanitize
+ \else
+ \dosubindwrite
+ \fi
+ }%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
+%
+\def\dosubindwrite{%
+ % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
+ \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
+ \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Remember, we are within a group.
+ \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
+ \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
+ % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
+ %
+ % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
+ % get the string to sort by.
+ {\indexnofonts
+ \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
+ \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
+ }%
+ %
+ % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
+ % the original text, including any font commands. We write
+ % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
+ % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
+ % sorted result.
+ \edef\temp{%
+ \write\writeto{%
+ \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
+ }%
+ \temp
+}
+
+% Take care of unwanted page breaks:
+%
+% If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
+% by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
+% the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
+% \write will make \lastskip zero. The result is that sequences
+% like this:
+% @end defun
+% @tindex whatever
+% @defun ...
+% will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
+% start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
+% the previous defun.
+%
+% But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
+% don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
+%
+% Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
+%
+% But wait, there is a catch there:
+% We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
+% sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
+% of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
+% representation of the skip.
+%
+% The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
+% the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
+%
+\edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
+%
+% ..., ready, GO:
+%
+\def\dosubindsanitize{%
+ % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
+ \skip0 = \lastskip
+ \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
+ \count255 = \lastpenalty
+ %
+ % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
+ % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
+ % -\skip0 glue we're inserting is preceded by a
+ % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
+ % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
+ \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
+ \else
+ \vskip-\skip0
+ \fi
+ %
+ \dosubindwrite
+ %
+ \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
+ % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
+ % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
+ % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
+ % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
+ % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
+ %
+ % @deffn deffn-whatever
+ % @vindex index-whatever
+ % Description.
+ % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
+ % and the "Description." paragraph.
+ \ifnum\count255>9999 \penalty\count255 \fi
+ \else
+ % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
+ % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
+ % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
+ \nobreak\vskip\skip0
+ \fi
+}
+
+% The index entry written in the file actually looks like
+% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
+% or
+% \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
+% The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
+% containing these kinds of lines:
+% \initial {c}
+% before the first topic whose initial is c
+% \entry {topic}{pagelist}
+% for a topic that is used without subtopics
+% \primary {topic}
+% for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
+% \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
+% for each subtopic.
+
+% Define the user-accessible indexing commands
+% @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
+
+\def\findex {\fnindex}
+\def\kindex {\kyindex}
+\def\cindex {\cpindex}
+\def\vindex {\vrindex}
+\def\tindex {\tpindex}
+\def\pindex {\pgindex}
+
+\def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
+{\obeylines %
+\gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
+\dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
+
+% Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
+
+% @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
+% It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
+%
+\parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
+ \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
+ %
+ \smallfonts \rm
+ \tolerance = 9500
+ \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
+ %
+ % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
+ % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
+ % \initial {@}
+ % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
+ % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
+ \catcode`\@ = 11
+ \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
+ \ifeof 1
+ % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
+ % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
+ % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
+ % there is some text.
+ \putwordIndexNonexistent
+ \else
+ %
+ % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
+ % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
+ % it can discover if there is anything in it.
+ \read 1 to \temp
+ \ifeof 1
+ \putwordIndexIsEmpty
+ \else
+ % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
+ % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
+ % to make right now.
+ \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
+ \catcode`\\ = 0
+ \escapechar = `\\
+ \begindoublecolumns
+ \input \jobname.#1s
+ \enddoublecolumns
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+\endgroup}
+
+% These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
+% Change them to control the appearance of the index.
+
+\def\initial#1{{%
+ % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
+ \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
+ %
+ % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
+ \removelastskip
+ %
+ % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
+ \nobreak
+ \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
+ \penalty 0
+ \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
+ %
+ % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
+ % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
+ % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
+ % we need before each entry, but it's better.
+ %
+ % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
+ \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
+ \leftline{\secbf #1}%
+ % Do our best not to break after the initial.
+ \nobreak
+ \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
+}}
+
+% \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
+% then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
+% and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
+%
+% A straightforward implementation would start like this:
+% \def\entry#1#2{...
+% But this frozes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
+% @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
+% ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
+%
+% The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
+% --kasal, 21nov03
+\def\entry{%
+ \begingroup
+ %
+ % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
+ % affect previous text.
+ \par
+ %
+ % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
+ \parfillskip = 0in
+ %
+ % No extra space above this paragraph.
+ \parskip = 0in
+ %
+ % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
+ \finalhyphendemerits = 0
+ %
+ % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
+ % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
+ % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
+ % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
+ % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
+ %
+ % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
+ % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
+ \hangindent = 2em
+ %
+ % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
+ % with blank space.
+ \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
+ %
+ % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
+ % columns.
+ \vskip 0pt plus1pt
+ %
+ % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
+ \afterassignment\doentry
+ \let\temp =
+}
+\def\doentry{%
+ \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
+ \noindent
+ \aftergroup\finishentry
+ % And now comes the text of the entry.
+}
+\def\finishentry#1{%
+ % #1 is the page number.
+ %
+ % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
+ % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
+ % cursed by a Unix daemon.
+ \def\tempa{{\rm }}%
+ \def\tempb{#1}%
+ \edef\tempc{\tempa}%
+ \edef\tempd{\tempb}%
+ \ifx\tempc\tempd
+ \ %
+ \else
+ %
+ % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
+ % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
+ % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
+ \hfil\penalty50
+ \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
+ %
+ % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
+ % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
+ % \hbox ensues.
+ \ifpdf
+ \pdfgettoks#1.%
+ \ \the\toksA
+ \else
+ \ #1%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \par
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+% Like \dotfill except takes at least 1 em.
+\def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
+ \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu ${\it .}$ \mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
+
+\def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
+
+\newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
+\def\secondary#1#2{{%
+ \parfillskip=0in
+ \parskip=0in
+ \hangindent=1in
+ \hangafter=1
+ \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
+ \ifpdf
+ \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
+ \else
+ #2
+ \fi
+ \par
+}}
+
+% Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
+% Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
+% the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
+\catcode`\@=11
+
+\newbox\partialpage
+\newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
+
+\def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
+ % Grab any single-column material above us.
+ \output = {%
+ %
+ % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
+ % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
+ % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
+ % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
+ % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
+ % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
+ % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
+ \ifvoid\partialpage \else
+ \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
+ % Unvbox the main output page.
+ \unvbox\PAGE
+ \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
+ }%
+ }%
+ \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
+ %
+ % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
+ \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
+ %
+ % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
+ % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
+ % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
+ % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
+ % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
+ %
+ % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
+ % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
+ % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
+ % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
+ % as it did when we hard-coded it.
+ %
+ % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
+ % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
+ % been clobbered.
+ %
+ \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
+ \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
+ \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
+ \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
+ %
+ % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
+ % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
+ \vsize = 2\vsize
+}
+
+% The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
+% the last.
+%
+\def\doublecolumnout{%
+ \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
+ % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
+ % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
+ % previous page.
+ \dimen@ = \vsize
+ \divide\dimen@ by 2
+ \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
+ %
+ % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
+ \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
+ \onepageout\pagesofar
+ \unvbox255
+ \penalty\outputpenalty
+}
+%
+% Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
+% followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
+\def\pagesofar{%
+ \unvbox\partialpage
+ %
+ \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
+ \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
+ \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
+}
+%
+% All done with double columns.
+\def\enddoublecolumns{%
+ \output = {%
+ % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
+ % current page, no automatic page break.
+ \balancecolumns
+ %
+ % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
+ % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
+ % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
+ % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
+ % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
+ % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
+ % the output somewhat more palatable.)
+ \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
+ }%
+ \eject
+ \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
+ %
+ % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
+ % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
+ % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
+ % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
+ \pagegoal = \vsize
+}
+%
+% Called at the end of the double column material.
+\def\balancecolumns{%
+ \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
+ \dimen@ = \ht0
+ \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
+ \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
+ \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
+ %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
+ \splittopskip = \topskip
+ % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
+ {%
+ \vbadness = 10000
+ \loop
+ \global\setbox3 = \copy0
+ \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
+ \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
+ \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
+ \repeat
+ }%
+ %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
+ \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
+ \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
+ %
+ \pagesofar
+}
+\catcode`\@ = \other
+
+
+\message{sectioning,}
+% Chapters, sections, etc.
+
+% \unnumberedno is an oxymoron, of course. But we count the unnumbered
+% sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
+% outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
+% numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
+% chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
+\newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
+\newcount\chapno
+\newcount\secno \secno=0
+\newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
+\newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
+
+% This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
+\newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
+%
+% \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
+% We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
+% construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
+% letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
+%
+\def\appendixletter{%
+ \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
+ \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
+ % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
+ % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
+ % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
+ % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
+ \else\char\the\appendixno
+ \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
+ \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
+
+% Each @chapter defines this as the name of the chapter.
+% page headings and footings can use it. @section does likewise.
+% However, they are not reliable, because we don't use marks.
+\def\thischapter{}
+\def\thissection{}
+
+\newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
+\newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
+
+% @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
+\def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
+\let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
+
+% @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
+\def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
+\let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
+
+% we only have subsub.
+\chardef\maxseclevel = 3
+%
+% A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
+% To achive this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
+\chardef\unmlevel = \maxseclevel
+%
+% Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
+% \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
+\def\chapheadtype{N}
+
+% Choose a heading macro
+% #1 is heading type
+% #2 is heading level
+% #3 is text for heading
+\def\genhead#1#2#3{%
+ % Compute the abs. sec. level:
+ \absseclevel=#2
+ \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
+ % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
+ \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
+ \absseclevel = 0
+ \else
+ \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
+ \absseclevel = 3
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ % The heading type:
+ \def\headtype{#1}%
+ \if \headtype U%
+ \ifnum \absseclevel < \unmlevel
+ \chardef\unmlevel = \absseclevel
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % Check for appendix sections:
+ \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
+ \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
+ \else
+ \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
+ \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
+ \fi\fi
+ \fi
+ % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
+ \ifnum \absseclevel > \unmlevel
+ \def\headtype{U}%
+ \else
+ \chardef\unmlevel = 3
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ % Now print the heading:
+ \if \headtype U%
+ \ifcase\absseclevel
+ \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
+ \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \if \headtype A%
+ \ifcase\absseclevel
+ \appendixzzz{#3}%
+ \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
+ \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \ifcase\absseclevel
+ \chapterzzz{#3}%
+ \or \seczzz{#3}%
+ \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% an interface:
+\def\numhead{\genhead N}
+\def\apphead{\genhead A}
+\def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
+
+% @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
+% all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
+%
+% Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
+% (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
+\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
+%
+\outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
+\def\chapterzzz#1{%
+ % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
+ % as an @include file.
+ \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
+ \global\advance\chapno by 1
+ %
+ % Used for \float.
+ \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
+ \resetallfloatnos
+ %
+ \message{\putwordChapter\space \the\chapno}%
+ %
+ % Write the actual heading.
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
+ %
+ % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
+ \global\let\section = \numberedsec
+ \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
+ \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally apphead0 calls appendixzzz
+\def\appendixzzz#1{%
+ \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
+ \global\advance\appendixno by 1
+ \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
+ \resetallfloatnos
+ %
+ \def\appendixnum{\putwordAppendix\space \appendixletter}%
+ \message{\appendixnum}%
+ %
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
+ %
+ \global\let\section = \appendixsec
+ \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
+ \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz
+\def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
+ \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
+ \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
+ %
+ % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
+ \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
+ \resetallfloatnos
+ %
+ % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
+ % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
+ % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
+ % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
+ % to be executed, not expanded).
+ %
+ % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
+ % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
+ % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
+ % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
+ % the toc entries.)
+ \toks0 = {#1}%
+ \message{(\the\toks0)}%
+ %
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
+ %
+ \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
+ \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
+ \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
+}
+
+% @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
+\outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
+ % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
+ % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
+ % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
+ \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
+ \unnmhead0{#1}%
+ \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
+}
+
+% @top is like @unnumbered.
+\let\top\unnumbered
+
+% Sections.
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
+\def\seczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} % normally calls appendixsectionzzz
+\def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
+ \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
+}
+\let\appendixsec\appendixsection
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} % normally calls unnumberedseczzz
+\def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
+}
+
+% Subsections.
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} % normally calls numberedsubseczzz
+\def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} % normally calls appendixsubseczzz
+\def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
+ {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} %normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz
+\def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
+ {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
+}
+
+% Subsubsections.
+\outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} % normally numberedsubsubseczzz
+\def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
+ {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} % normally appendixsubsubseczzz
+\def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
+ {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
+}
+
+\outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} %normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz
+\def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
+ \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
+ \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
+ {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
+}
+
+% These macros control what the section commands do, according
+% to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
+% Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
+\let\section = \numberedsec
+\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
+\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
+
+% Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
+
+% NOTE on use of \vbox for chapter headings, section headings, and such:
+% 1) We use \vbox rather than the earlier \line to permit
+% overlong headings to fold.
+% 2) \hyphenpenalty is set to 10000 because hyphenation in a
+% heading is obnoxious; this forbids it.
+% 3) Likewise, headings look best if no \parindent is used, and
+% if justification is not attempted. Hence \raggedright.
+
+
+\def\majorheading{%
+ {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
+ \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
+}
+
+\def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
+\def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
+ {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}%
+ \bigskip \par\penalty 200\relax
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
+\parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
+\parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
+ \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
+
+% These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
+% (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
+% given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
+
+%%% Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
+\def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
+
+%%% Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it
+% Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
+
+\newskip\chapheadingskip
+
+\def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
+\def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
+\def\chapoddpage{\chappager \ifodd\pageno \else \hbox to 0pt{} \chappager\fi}
+
+\def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
+
+\def\CHAPPAGoff{%
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
+\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
+\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
+
+\def\CHAPPAGon{%
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
+\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
+\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
+\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
+
+\def\CHAPPAGodd{%
+\global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
+\global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
+\global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
+\global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
+
+\CHAPPAGon
+
+% Chapter opening.
+%
+% #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
+% Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
+%
+% To test against our argument.
+\def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
+\def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
+\def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
+%
+\def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
+ \pchapsepmacro
+ {%
+ \chapfonts \rm
+ %
+ % Have to define \thissection before calling \donoderef, because the
+ % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
+ % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
+ \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \gdef\thischaptername{#1}%
+ %
+ % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
+ % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
+ \def\temptype{#2}%
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
+ \def\toctype{unnchap}%
+ \gdef\thischapter{#1}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
+ \def\toctype{omit}%
+ \gdef\thischapter{}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{app}%
+ % We don't substitute the actual chapter name into \thischapter
+ % because we don't want its macros evaluated now. And we don't
+ % use \thissection because that changes with each section.
+ %
+ \xdef\thischapter{\putwordAppendix{} \appendixletter:
+ \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+ \else
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{numchap}%
+ \xdef\thischapter{\putwordChapter{} \the\chapno:
+ \noexpand\thischaptername}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
+ % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
+ % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
+ \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
+ %
+ % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
+ % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
+ % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
+ % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
+ % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
+ \donoderef{#2}%
+ %
+ % Typeset the actual heading.
+ \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
+ \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
+ \unhbox0 #1\par}%
+ }%
+ \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
+ \nobreak
+}
+
+% @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
+\let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
+\def\centerparameters{%
+ \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
+ \leftskip = \rightskip
+ \parfillskip = 0pt
+}
+
+
+% I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
+% updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
+%
+\def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
+%
+\def\unnchfopen #1{%
+\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt\raggedright
+ \rm #1\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
+}
+\def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
+\vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
+\par\penalty 5000 %
+}
+\def\centerchfopen #1{%
+\chapoddpage {\chapfonts \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000\tolerance=5000
+ \parindent=0pt
+ \hfill {\rm #1}\hfill}}\bigskip \par\nobreak
+}
+\def\CHAPFopen{%
+ \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
+ \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
+
+
+% Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
+% call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
+%
+\newskip\secheadingskip
+\def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
+
+% Subsection titles.
+\newskip\subsecheadingskip
+\def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
+
+% Subsubsection titles.
+\def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
+\def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
+
+
+% Print any size, any type, section title.
+%
+% #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
+% the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
+% section number.
+%
+\def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
+ {%
+ % Switch to the right set of fonts.
+ \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rm
+ %
+ % Insert space above the heading.
+ \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
+ %
+ % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
+ \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
+ \def\temptype{#3}%
+ %
+ \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
+ \def\toctype{unn}%
+ \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
+ % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
+ % and don't redefine \thissection.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
+ \def\toctype{omit}%
+ \let\sectionlevel=\empty
+ \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{app}%
+ \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \else
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
+ \def\toctype{num}%
+ \gdef\thissection{#1}%
+ \fi\fi\fi
+ %
+ % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chfplain.
+ \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
+ %
+ % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
+ % Again, see comments in \chfplain.
+ \donoderef{#3}%
+ %
+ % Output the actual section heading.
+ \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \raggedright
+ \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
+ \unhbox0 #1}%
+ }%
+ % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
+ % Don't allow stretch, though.
+ \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
+ %
+ % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
+ % was followed by glue.
+ \nobreak
+ %
+ % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
+ % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
+ % discardable item.)
+ \vskip-\parskip
+ %
+ % This is purely so the last item on the list is a known \penalty >
+ % 10000. This is so \startdefun can avoid allowing breakpoints after
+ % section headings. Otherwise, it would insert a valid breakpoint between:
+ %
+ % @section sec-whatever
+ % @deffn def-whatever
+ \penalty 10001
+}
+
+
+\message{toc,}
+% Table of contents.
+\newwrite\tocfile
+
+% Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
+% Called from @chapter, etc.
+%
+% Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
+% We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
+% arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
+% read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
+% destination to jump to.
+%
+% We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
+% any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
+% But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
+% table of contents chapter openings themselves.
+%
+\newif\iftocfileopened
+\def\omitkeyword{omit}%
+%
+\def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
+ \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
+ \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
+ \iftocfileopened\else
+ \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
+ \global\tocfileopenedtrue
+ \fi
+ %
+ \iflinks
+ {\atdummies
+ \edef\temp{%
+ \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
+ \temp
+ }
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
+ % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
+ % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
+ % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
+ % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
+ % `1', and two named `2'.
+ \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
+}
+
+
+% These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
+% fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
+% with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
+%
+\def\activecatcodes{%
+ \catcode`\"=\active
+ \catcode`\$=\active
+ \catcode`\<=\active
+ \catcode`\>=\active
+ \catcode`\\=\active
+ \catcode`\^=\active
+ \catcode`\_=\active
+ \catcode`\|=\active
+ \catcode`\~=\active
+}
+
+
+% Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
+\def\readtocfile{%
+ \setupdatafile
+ \activecatcodes
+ \input \jobname.toc
+}
+
+\newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
+\newcount\savepageno
+\newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
+
+% Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
+%
+\def\startcontents#1{%
+ % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
+ % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
+ % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
+ % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
+ \contentsalignmacro
+ \immediate\closeout\tocfile
+ %
+ % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
+ % It is abundantly clear what they are.
+ \def\thischapter{}%
+ \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
+ %
+ \savepageno = \pageno
+ \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
+ \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
+ \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
+ %
+ % Roman numerals for page numbers.
+ \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
+}
+
+
+% Normal (long) toc.
+\def\contents{%
+ \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
+ \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \readtocfile
+ \fi
+ \vfill \eject
+ \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \pdfmakeoutlines
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \endgroup
+ \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
+ \global\pageno = \savepageno
+}
+
+% And just the chapters.
+\def\summarycontents{%
+ \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
+ %
+ \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
+ \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
+ \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
+ % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
+ \secfonts
+ \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
+ \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
+ \rm
+ \hyphenpenalty = 10000
+ \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
+ \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
+ \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
+ \openin 1 \jobname.toc
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \readtocfile
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \vfill \eject
+ \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
+ \endgroup
+ \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
+ \global\pageno = \savepageno
+}
+\let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
+
+% Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
+% The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
+%
+\def\shortchaplabel#1{%
+ % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
+ % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
+ % But use \hss just in case.
+ % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
+ % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
+ %
+ % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
+ % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
+ % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
+ % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
+ % there are before deciding ...
+ \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
+}
+
+% These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
+% The first argument is the chapter or section name.
+% The last argument is the page number.
+% The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
+
+% Chapters, in the main contents.
+\def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+%
+% Chapters, in the short toc.
+% See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
+\def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
+ \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
+}
+
+% Appendices, in the main contents.
+% Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
+%
+\def\appendixbox#1{%
+ % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
+ \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
+%
+\def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+
+% Unnumbered chapters.
+\def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
+\def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
+
+% Sections.
+\def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
+\def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
+
+% Subsections.
+\def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
+\def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
+
+% And subsubsections.
+\def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
+\let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
+\def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
+
+% This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
+% Same as \defaultparindent.
+\newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
+
+% Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
+% page number.
+%
+% If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
+% if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
+\def\dochapentry#1#2{%
+ \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
+ \begingroup
+ \chapentryfonts
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
+ \endgroup
+ \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
+}
+
+\def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
+\endgroup}
+
+\def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
+\endgroup}
+
+\def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
+ \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
+ \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
+\endgroup}
+
+% We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
+\let\tocentry = \entry
+
+% Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
+\def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
+
+\def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
+\def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
+
+\def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
+\def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
+\def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
+\def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
+
+
+\message{environments,}
+% @foo ... @end foo.
+
+% @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
+%
+% Since these characters are used in examples, it should be an even number of
+% \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
+%
+\def\point{$\star$}
+\def\result{\leavevmode\raise.15ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
+\def\expansion{\leavevmode\raise.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
+\def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
+\def\equiv{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
+
+% The @error{} command.
+% Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
+%
+\newbox\errorbox
+%
+{\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
+\dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
+% The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
+\setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \tensf error\kern-1.5pt}
+%
+\setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
+ \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
+ \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
+ \vbox{%
+ \hrule height\dimen2
+ \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
+ \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
+ \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
+ \hrule height\dimen2}
+ \hfil}
+%
+\def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
+
+% @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw Tex temporarily.
+% One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
+% But \@ or @@ will get a plain tex @ character.
+
+\envdef\tex{%
+ \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
+ \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
+ \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
+ \catcode `\%=14
+ \catcode `\+=\other
+ \catcode `\"=\other
+ \catcode `\|=\other
+ \catcode `\<=\other
+ \catcode `\>=\other
+ \escapechar=`\\
+ %
+ \let\b=\ptexb
+ \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
+ \let\c=\ptexc
+ \let\,=\ptexcomma
+ \let\.=\ptexdot
+ \let\dots=\ptexdots
+ \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
+ \let\!=\ptexexclam
+ \let\i=\ptexi
+ \let\indent=\ptexindent
+ \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
+ \let\{=\ptexlbrace
+ \let\+=\tabalign
+ \let\}=\ptexrbrace
+ \let\/=\ptexslash
+ \let\*=\ptexstar
+ \let\t=\ptext
+ \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
+ %
+ \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
+ \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
+ \def\@{@}%
+}
+% There is no need to define \Etex.
+
+% Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
+% @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
+% including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
+
+% Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
+\newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
+
+% This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
+% such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
+% have any width.
+\def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
+
+% This space is always present above and below environments.
+\newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
+
+% Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
+% to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
+% is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
+% start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
+%
+\def\aboveenvbreak{{%
+ % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
+ % \sectionheading, q.v.
+ \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
+ \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
+ \endgraf
+ \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
+ \removelastskip
+ % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
+ % or better ...
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
+ \vskip\envskipamount
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}}
+
+\let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
+
+% \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
+% also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
+\let\nonarrowing=\relax
+
+% @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
+% environment contents.
+\font\circle=lcircle10
+\newdimen\circthick
+\newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
+\newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
+\circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
+%
+\def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
+\def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
+\def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
+\def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
+\def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
+ \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
+ \hskip\rskip}}
+\def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
+ \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
+ \hskip\rskip}}
+%
+\newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
+
+\envdef\cartouche{%
+ \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
+ \startsavinginserts
+ \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
+ \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
+ \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
+ \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
+ \cartouter=\hsize
+ \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
+ % side, and for 6pt waste from
+ % each corner char, and rule thickness
+ \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
+ % Flag to tell @lisp, etc., not to narrow margin.
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
+ \carttop
+ \hbox\bgroup
+ \hskip\lskip
+ \vrule\kern3pt
+ \vbox\bgroup
+ \kern3pt
+ \hsize=\cartinner
+ \baselineskip=\normbskip
+ \lineskip=\normlskip
+ \parskip=\normpskip
+ \vskip -\parskip
+ \comment % For explanation, see the end of \def\group.
+}
+\def\Ecartouche{%
+ \ifhmode\par\fi
+ \kern3pt
+ \egroup
+ \kern3pt\vrule
+ \hskip\rskip
+ \egroup
+ \cartbot
+ \egroup
+ \checkinserts
+}
+
+
+% This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
+% inside a group.
+\def\nonfillstart{%
+ \aboveenvbreak
+ \hfuzz = 12pt % Don't be fussy
+ \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
+ \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
+ \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
+ \parskip = 0pt
+ \parindent = 0pt
+ \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
+ \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
+ \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
+ \else
+ \let\nonarrowing = \relax
+ \fi
+ \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
+}
+
+% If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
+% If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
+% This affects the following displayed environments:
+% @example, @display, @format, @lisp
+%
+\def\smallword{small}
+\def\nosmallword{nosmall}
+\let\SETdispenvsize\relax
+\def\setnormaldispenv{%
+ \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
+ \smallexamplefonts \rm
+ \fi
+}
+\def\setsmalldispenv{%
+ \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
+ \else
+ \smallexamplefonts \rm
+ \fi
+}
+
+% We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
+% Let's do it by one command:
+\def\makedispenv #1#2{
+ \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}
+ \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}
+ \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
+ \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
+}
+
+% Define two synonyms:
+\def\maketwodispenvs #1#2#3{
+ \makedispenv{#1}{#3}
+ \makedispenv{#2}{#3}
+}
+
+% @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; @example: same as @lisp.
+%
+% @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
+% Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
+%
+\maketwodispenvs {lisp}{example}{%
+ \nonfillstart
+ \tt
+ \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
+ \gobble % eat return
+}
+
+% @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
+%
+\makedispenv {display}{%
+ \nonfillstart
+ \gobble
+}
+
+% @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
+%
+\makedispenv{format}{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \nonfillstart
+ \gobble
+}
+
+% @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
+\envdef\flushleft{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \nonfillstart
+ \gobble
+}
+\let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
+
+% @flushright.
+%
+\envdef\flushright{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \nonfillstart
+ \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill
+ \gobble
+}
+\let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
+
+
+% @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
+% and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
+% we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
+% \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
+%
+\envdef\quotation{%
+ {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
+ \parindent=0pt
+ %
+ % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
+ \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
+ \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
+ \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
+ \else
+ \let\nonarrowing = \relax
+ \fi
+ \parsearg\quotationlabel
+}
+
+% We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
+% doing normal filling.
+%
+\def\Equotation{%
+ \par
+ \ifx\quotationauthor\undefined\else
+ % indent a bit.
+ \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
+ \fi
+ {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
+}
+
+% If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
+\def\quotationlabel#1{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \ifx\temp\empty \else
+ {\bf #1: }%
+ \fi
+}
+
+
+% LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
+% If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
+% we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
+% `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
+%
+% [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
+%
+% [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
+% active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
+% verbatim line.
+\def\dospecials{%
+ \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
+ \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
+ \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
+}
+%
+% [Knuth] p. 380
+\def\uncatcodespecials{%
+ \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
+%
+% [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
+% Disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\`=\active\gdef`{\relax\lq}
+\endgroup
+%
+% Setup for the @verb command.
+%
+% Eight spaces for a tab
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^I=\active
+ \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
+\endgroup
+%
+\def\setupverb{%
+ \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
+ \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
+ \catcode`\`=\active
+ \tabeightspaces
+ % Respect line breaks,
+ % print special symbols as themselves, and
+ % make each space count
+ % must do in this order:
+ \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
+}
+
+% Setup for the @verbatim environment
+%
+% Real tab expansion
+\newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
+%
+\def\starttabbox{\setbox0=\hbox\bgroup}
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^I=\active
+ \gdef\tabexpand{%
+ \catcode`\^^I=\active
+ \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
+ \dimen0=\wd0 % the width so far, or since the previous tab
+ \divide\dimen0 by\tabw
+ \multiply\dimen0 by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
+ \advance\dimen0 by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
+ \wd0=\dimen0 \box0 \starttabbox
+ }%
+ }
+\endgroup
+\def\setupverbatim{%
+ \let\nonarrowing = t%
+ \nonfillstart
+ % Easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
+ \tt
+ \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box0\endgraf}%
+ \catcode`\`=\active
+ \tabexpand
+ % Respect line breaks,
+ % print special symbols as themselves, and
+ % make each space count
+ % must do in this order:
+ \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
+ \everypar{\starttabbox}%
+}
+
+% Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
+% delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
+% right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
+%
+% \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
+%
+% [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
+ \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
+\endgroup
+%
+\def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
+%
+%
+% Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
+% the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
+%
+% \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
+%
+% For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
+% because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
+% we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
+%
+% Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
+%
+\begingroup
+ \catcode`\ =\active
+ \obeylines %
+ % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
+ % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
+ % line in the output.
+ \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
+ % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
+ % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
+\endgroup
+%
+\envdef\verbatim{%
+ \setupverbatim\doverbatim
+}
+\let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
+
+
+% @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
+%
+\def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
+%
+\def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
+ {%
+ \makevalueexpandable
+ \setupverbatim
+ \input #1
+ \afterenvbreak
+ }%
+}
+
+% @copying ... @end copying.
+% Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
+%
+% We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
+% Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
+% typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
+% beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
+% file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
+% possible is very desirable.
+%
+\def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
+\def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
+%
+\def\insertcopying{%
+ \begingroup
+ \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
+ \scanexp\copyingtext
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+\message{defuns,}
+% @defun etc.
+
+\newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
+\newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
+\newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
+
+% Start the processing of @deffn:
+\def\startdefun{%
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
+ \medbreak
+ \else
+ % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
+ % which is there to keep the function description together with its
+ % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
+ % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
+ % by \defargscommonending, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
+ % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
+ % a break between a section heading and a defun.
+ %
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \fi
+ %
+ % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
+ % But do insert the glue.
+ \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
+ \fi
+ %
+ \parindent=0in
+ \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
+ \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+}
+
+\def\dodefunx#1{%
+ % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
+ \checkenv#1%
+ %
+ % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
+ % It's not a great place, though.
+ \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \fi
+ %
+ % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
+ \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
+}
+\def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
+
+% \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
+%
+\def\printdefunline#1#2{%
+ \begingroup
+ % call \deffnheader:
+ #1#2 \endheader
+ % common ending:
+ \interlinepenalty = 10000
+ \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil
+ \endgraf
+ \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
+ \penalty 10002 % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
+ % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
+ % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
+ \checkparencounts
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+\def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
+
+% \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
+% the only thing remainnig is to define \deffnheader.
+%
+\def\makedefun#1{%
+ \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
+ \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
+ \temp
+}
+
+% \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
+%
+% Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
+% \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
+%
+\def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
+ \envdef#1{%
+ \startdefun
+ \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
+ }%
+ \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
+ \def#3%
+}
+
+%%% Untyped functions:
+
+% @deffn category name args
+\makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
+
+% @deffn category class name args
+\makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
+
+% \defopon {category on}class name args
+\def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+
+% \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
+%
+\def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
+ % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
+ \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
+ \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
+}
+
+%%% Typed functions:
+
+% @deftypefn category type name args
+\makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
+
+% @deftypeop category class type name args
+\makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
+
+% \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
+\def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+
+% \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
+%
+\def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
+ \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
+ \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
+}
+
+%%% Typed variables:
+
+% @deftypevr category type var args
+\makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
+
+% @deftypecv category class type var args
+\makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
+
+% \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
+\def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
+
+% \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
+%
+\def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
+ \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
+ \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
+}
+
+%%% Untyped variables:
+
+% @defvr category var args
+\makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
+
+% @defcv category class var args
+\makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
+
+% \defcvof {category of}class var args
+\def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
+
+%%% Type:
+% @deftp category name args
+\makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
+ \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
+ \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
+}
+
+% Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
+\makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
+\makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
+\makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
+\makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
+\makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
+\makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
+\makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
+\makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
+\makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
+\makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
+\makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
+
+% \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
+% #1 is the category, such as "Function".
+% #2 is the return type, if any.
+% #3 is the function name.
+%
+% We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
+%
+\def\defname#1#2#3{%
+ % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
+ \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
+ %
+ % How we'll format the type name. Putting it in brackets helps
+ % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
+ % just below it.
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
+ %
+ % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape.
+ % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
+ % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
+ \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
+ % The continuations:
+ \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
+ % (plain.tex says that \dimen1 should be used only as global.)
+ \parshape 2 0in \dimen0 \defargsindent \dimen2
+ %
+ % Put the type name to the right margin.
+ \noindent
+ \hbox to 0pt{%
+ \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
+ % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
+ \kern\leftskip
+ % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
+ }%
+ %
+ % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
+ \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
+ \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
+ {%
+ % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
+ % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
+ % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
+ % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
+ % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
+ % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
+ % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
+ % one has made identifiers using them :).
+ \df \tt
+ \def\temp{#2}% return value type
+ \ifx\temp\empty\else \tclose{\temp} \fi
+ #3% output function name
+ }%
+ {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
+ %
+ \boldbrax
+ % arguments will be output next, if any.
+}
+
+% Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
+% tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
+% the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
+% distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
+%
+\def\defunargs#1{%
+ % use sl by default (not ttsl),
+ % tt for the names.
+ \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
+ %
+ % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
+ % want a way to get ttsl. Let's try @var for that.
+ \let\var=\ttslanted
+ #1%
+ \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
+}
+
+% We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
+%
+\def\activeparens{%
+ \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
+ \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
+ \catcode`\&=\active
+}
+
+% Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
+\let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
+
+% Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
+% if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
+% so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
+{
+ \activeparens
+ \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
+ \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
+ \global\let& = \&
+
+ \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
+ \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
+}
+
+\newcount\parencount
+
+% If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
+\newif\ifampseen
+\def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
+
+\def\parenfont{%
+ \ifampseen
+ % At the first level, print parens in roman,
+ % otherwise use the default font.
+ \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
+ \else
+ % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
+ % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
+ \sf
+ \fi
+}
+\def\infirstlevel#1{%
+ \ifampseen
+ \ifnum\parencount=1
+ #1%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+}
+\def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
+
+\def\opnr{%
+ \global\advance\parencount by 1
+ {\parenfont(}%
+ \infirstlevel \bfafterword
+}
+\def\clnr{%
+ {\parenfont)}%
+ \infirstlevel \sl
+ \global\advance\parencount by -1
+}
+
+\newcount\brackcount
+\def\lbrb{%
+ \global\advance\brackcount by 1
+ {\bf[}%
+}
+\def\rbrb{%
+ {\bf]}%
+ \global\advance\brackcount by -1
+}
+
+\def\checkparencounts{%
+ \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
+ \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
+}
+\def\badparencount{%
+ \errmessage{Unbalanced parentheses in @def}%
+ \global\parencount=0
+}
+\def\badbrackcount{%
+ \errmessage{Unbalanced square braces in @def}%
+ \global\brackcount=0
+}
+
+
+\message{macros,}
+% @macro.
+
+% To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
+% which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
+\ifx\eTeXversion\undefined
+ \newwrite\macscribble
+ \def\scantokens#1{%
+ \toks0={#1}%
+ \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
+ \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
+ \immediate\closeout\macscribble
+ \input \jobname.tmp
+ }
+\fi
+
+\def\scanmacro#1{%
+ \begingroup
+ \newlinechar`\^^M
+ \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
+ % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
+ % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
+ % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
+ % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
+ % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
+ \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
+ % ... and \example
+ \spaceisspace
+ %
+ % Append \endinput to make sure that TeX does not see the ending newline.
+ %
+ % I've verified that it is necessary both for e-TeX and for ordinary TeX
+ % --kasal, 29nov03
+ \scantokens{#1\endinput}%
+ \endgroup
+}
+
+\def\scanexp#1{%
+ \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
+ \temp
+}
+
+\newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
+\newtoks\macname % Macro name
+\newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
+
+% List of all defined macros in the form
+% \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
+% Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
+% if there is a need.
+\def\macrolist{}
+
+% Add the macro to \macrolist
+\def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
+\def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
+ \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
+}
+
+% Utility routines.
+% This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
+% \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
+% (except of course we have to play expansion games).
+%
+\def\cslet#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\let
+ \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
+ \csname#2\endcsname
+}
+
+% Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
+% Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
+{\catcode`\@=11
+\gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
+\gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
+\gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
+\def\unbrace#1{#1}
+\unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
+}
+
+% Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
+{\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
+\gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
+\gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
+\gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
+}
+
+% Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
+% all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
+% (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \.
+
+% It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
+% done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
+% body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
+
+\def\scanctxt{%
+ \catcode`\"=\other
+ \catcode`\+=\other
+ \catcode`\<=\other
+ \catcode`\>=\other
+ \catcode`\@=\other
+ \catcode`\^=\other
+ \catcode`\_=\other
+ \catcode`\|=\other
+ \catcode`\~=\other
+}
+
+\def\scanargctxt{%
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+ \catcode`\^^M=\other
+}
+
+\def\macrobodyctxt{%
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\{=\other
+ \catcode`\}=\other
+ \catcode`\^^M=\other
+ \usembodybackslash
+}
+
+\def\macroargctxt{%
+ \scanctxt
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+}
+
+% \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
+% It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
+% where N is the macro parameter number.
+% We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
+% \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
+
+{\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
+ @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
+ @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
+}
+\expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
+
+\def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
+\def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
+
+\def\macroxxx#1{%
+ \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
+ \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
+ \paramno=0%
+ \else
+ \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
+ \fi
+ \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
+ \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
+ \else
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
+ \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
+ \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
+ \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
+ \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
+ \fi
+ \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
+ \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
+ \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
+ \fi}
+
+\parseargdef\unmacro{%
+ \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
+ \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
+ \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
+ % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
+ \begingroup
+ \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
+ \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
+ \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
+ \endgroup
+ \else
+ \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
+% macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
+%
+\def\unmacrodo#1{%
+ \ifx #1\relax
+ % remove this
+ \else
+ \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
+% <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
+% an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
+\def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
+\def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
+\def\getmacname #1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
+\def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
+
+% Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
+% so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.blah for each blah
+% in the params list, to be ##N where N is the position in that list.
+% That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
+
+% We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
+% The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
+% unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
+% it to # just before using the token list produced.
+%
+% The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
+% the macro is used.
+
+\def\parsemargdef#1;{\paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
+ \let\hash\relax\let\xeatspaces\relax\parsemargdefxxx#1,;,}
+\def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
+ \if#1;\let\next=\relax
+ \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
+ \advance\paramno by 1%
+ \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
+ {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
+ \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
+ \fi\next}
+
+% These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
+% (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
+
+\long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
+{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
+\long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
+{\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
+
+% This defines the macro itself. There are six cases: recursive and
+% nonrecursive macros of zero, one, and many arguments.
+% Much magic with \expandafter here.
+% \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
+% they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
+\def\defmacro{%
+ \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
+ \ifrecursive
+ \ifcase\paramno
+ % 0
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
+ \or % 1
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \noexpand\braceorline
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
+ \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
+ \else % many
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \expandafter\xdef
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
+ \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \ifcase\paramno
+ % 0
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
+ \or % 1
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \noexpand\braceorline
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
+ \egroup
+ \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
+ \else % many
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
+ \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
+ \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \expandafter\xdef
+ \expandafter\expandafter
+ \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
+ \paramlist{%
+ \egroup
+ \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
+ \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
+ \fi
+ \fi}
+
+\def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
+
+% \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
+% {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
+% line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
+% as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg)
+\def\braceorline#1{\let\next=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
+\def\braceorlinexxx{%
+ \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
+ \expandafter\parsearg
+ \fi \next}
+
+
+% @alias.
+% We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
+% sign. Just make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
+\def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
+\def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
+\def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
+ {%
+ \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
+ \addtomacrolist{#1}%
+ \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
+ }%
+ \next
+}
+
+
+\message{cross references,}
+
+\newwrite\auxfile
+
+\newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
+\newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
+
+% @inforef is relatively simple.
+\def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
+\def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{\putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
+ node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
+
+% @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
+% cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
+% might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
+% @node foo , bar , ...
+% We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
+%
+\parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
+%
+% also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
+% @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
+\def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
+\def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
+
+\let\nwnode=\node
+\let\lastnode=\empty
+
+% Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
+% type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
+%
+\def\donoderef#1{%
+ \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
+ \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
+ \global\let\lastnode=\empty
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
+%
+\newcount\savesfregister
+%
+\def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
+\def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
+\def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
+
+% \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
+% anchor), which consists of three parts:
+% 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \thissection,
+% or the anchor name.
+% 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
+% empty for anchors.
+% 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
+%
+% This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
+% floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
+% 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
+%
+\def\setref#1#2{%
+ \pdfmkdest{#1}%
+ \iflinks
+ {%
+ \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
+ \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
+ \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
+ ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
+ }%
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\thissection}%
+ \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
+ \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
+ \writexrdef{pg}{\folio}% will be written later, during \shipout
+ }%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
+% the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
+% node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
+% manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
+%
+\def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
+\def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
+ \unsepspaces
+ \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
+ \setbox1=\hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
+ \setbox0=\hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
+ \ifdim \wd0 = 0pt
+ % No printed node name was explicitly given.
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname\relax
+ % Use the node name inside the square brackets.
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \else
+ % Use the actual chapter/section title appear inside
+ % the square brackets. Use the real section title if we have it.
+ \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ % It is in another manual, so we don't have it.
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \else
+ \ifhavexrefs
+ % We know the real title if we have the xref values.
+ \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
+ \else
+ % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
+ \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
+ \fi%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Make link in pdf output.
+ \ifpdf
+ \leavevmode
+ \getfilename{#4}%
+ {\turnoffactive
+ % See comments at \activebackslashdouble.
+ {\activebackslashdouble \xdef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
+ \backslashparens\pdfxrefdest}%
+ %
+ \ifnum\filenamelength>0
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
+ goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
+ \else
+ \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
+ goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
+ \fi
+ }%
+ \linkcolor
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
+ % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
+ % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
+ {%
+ % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
+ % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
+ \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
+ }%
+ \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
+ % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
+ % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
+ \ifdim\wd0 = 0pt
+ \refx{#1-snt}%
+ \else
+ \printedrefname
+ \fi
+ %
+ % if the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
+ % "in MANUALNAME".
+ \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % node/anchor (non-float) references.
+ %
+ % If we use \unhbox0 and \unhbox1 to print the node names, TeX does not
+ % insert empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will
+ % not find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
+ % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, this
+ % is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name again, so it
+ % is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
+ \ifdim \wd1 > 0pt
+ \putwordsection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
+ \else
+ % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
+ % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
+ % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
+ % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
+ % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
+ {\turnoffactive
+ % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
+ % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
+ \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
+ \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
+ }%
+ % output the `[mynode]' via a macro so it can be overridden.
+ \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
+ %
+ % But we always want a comma and a space:
+ ,\space
+ %
+ % output the `page 3'.
+ \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \endlink
+\endgroup}
+
+% This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
+% output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
+% since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
+% one that Bob is working on :).
+%
+\def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
+
+% Things referred to by \setref.
+%
+\def\Ynothing{}
+\def\Yomitfromtoc{}
+\def\Ynumbered{%
+ \ifnum\secno=0
+ \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
+ \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
+ \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
+ \else
+ \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
+\def\Yappendix{%
+ \ifnum\secno=0
+ \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
+ \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
+ \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
+ \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
+ \else
+ \putwordSection@tie
+ @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
+ \fi\fi\fi
+}
+
+% Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
+% If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
+%
+\def\refx#1#2{%
+ {%
+ \indexnofonts
+ \otherbackslash
+ \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
+ \csname XR#1\endcsname
+ }%
+ \ifx\thisrefX\relax
+ % If not defined, say something at least.
+ \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
+ \iflinks
+ \ifhavexrefs
+ \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `#1'.}%
+ \else
+ \ifwarnedxrefs\else
+ \global\warnedxrefstrue
+ \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \fi
+ \else
+ % It's defined, so just use it.
+ \thisrefX
+ \fi
+ #2% Output the suffix in any case.
+}
+
+% This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
+% just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
+% collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
+%
+\def\xrdef#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\gdef\csname XR#1\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref value.
+ %
+ % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
+ \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR#1\endcsname
+ % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
+ \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
+ \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
+ %
+ % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
+ \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
+ \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
+ \else
+ % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
+ \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
+ % for later use in \listoffloats.
+ \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0{#1}}%
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
+%
+\def\tryauxfile{%
+ \openin 1 \jobname.aux
+ \ifeof 1 \else
+ \readdatafile{aux}%
+ \global\havexrefstrue
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+}
+
+\def\setupdatafile{%
+ \catcode`\^^@=\other
+ \catcode`\^^A=\other
+ \catcode`\^^B=\other
+ \catcode`\^^C=\other
+ \catcode`\^^D=\other
+ \catcode`\^^E=\other
+ \catcode`\^^F=\other
+ \catcode`\^^G=\other
+ \catcode`\^^H=\other
+ \catcode`\^^K=\other
+ \catcode`\^^L=\other
+ \catcode`\^^N=\other
+ \catcode`\^^P=\other
+ \catcode`\^^Q=\other
+ \catcode`\^^R=\other
+ \catcode`\^^S=\other
+ \catcode`\^^T=\other
+ \catcode`\^^U=\other
+ \catcode`\^^V=\other
+ \catcode`\^^W=\other
+ \catcode`\^^X=\other
+ \catcode`\^^Z=\other
+ \catcode`\^^[=\other
+ \catcode`\^^\=\other
+ \catcode`\^^]=\other
+ \catcode`\^^^=\other
+ \catcode`\^^_=\other
+ % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
+ % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
+ % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
+ % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
+ % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
+ % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
+ % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
+ % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
+ %
+ % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
+ % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
+ % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
+ %
+ \catcode`\^=\other
+ %
+ % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
+ \catcode`\~=\other
+ \catcode`\[=\other
+ \catcode`\]=\other
+ \catcode`\"=\other
+ \catcode`\_=\other
+ \catcode`\|=\other
+ \catcode`\<=\other
+ \catcode`\>=\other
+ \catcode`\$=\other
+ \catcode`\#=\other
+ \catcode`\&=\other
+ \catcode`\%=\other
+ \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
+ %
+ % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
+ % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
+ % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
+ % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
+ % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
+ % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
+ % now. --karl, 15jan04.
+ \catcode`\\=\other
+ %
+ % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
+ {%
+ \count1=128
+ \def\loop{%
+ \catcode\count1=\other
+ \advance\count1 by 1
+ \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
+ }%
+ }%
+ %
+ % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
+ \catcode`\{=1
+ \catcode`\}=2
+ \catcode`\@=0
+}
+
+\def\readdatafile#1{%
+\begingroup
+ \setupdatafile
+ \input\jobname.#1
+\endgroup}
+
+\message{insertions,}
+% including footnotes.
+
+\newcount \footnoteno
+
+% The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
+% vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
+% pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
+% removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
+% space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
+\def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
+
+% @footnotestyle is meaningful for info output only.
+\let\footnotestyle=\comment
+
+{\catcode `\@=11
+%
+% Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
+\gdef\footnote{%
+ \let\indent=\ptexindent
+ \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
+ \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
+ \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
+ %
+ % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
+ % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
+ \let\@sf\empty
+ \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
+ %
+ % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
+ \unskip
+ \thisfootno\@sf
+ \dofootnote
+}%
+
+% Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
+% footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
+%
+% Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
+% \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
+% the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
+%
+\gdef\dofootnote{%
+ \insert\footins\bgroup
+ % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
+ % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
+ % So reset some parameters.
+ \hsize=\pagewidth
+ \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
+ \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
+ \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
+ \floatingpenalty\@MM
+ \leftskip\z@skip
+ \rightskip\z@skip
+ \spaceskip\z@skip
+ \xspaceskip\z@skip
+ \parindent\defaultparindent
+ %
+ \smallfonts \rm
+ %
+ % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
+ % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
+ % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
+ % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
+ \let\noindent = \relax
+ %
+ % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
+ % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
+ \everypar = {\hang}%
+ \textindent{\thisfootno}%
+ %
+ % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
+ % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
+ % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
+ \footstrut
+ \futurelet\next\fo@t
+}
+}%end \catcode `\@=11
+
+% In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
+% the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
+% would be lost.
+% Similarily, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
+% text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
+% And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
+
+% Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
+% Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
+% out prematurely.
+%
+\def\startsavinginserts{%
+ \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
+ \let\insert\saveinsert
+ \else
+ \let\checkinserts\relax
+ \fi
+}
+
+% This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
+% \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
+%
+\def\saveinsert#1{%
+ \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
+ \afterassignment\next
+ % swallow the left brace
+ \let\temp =
+}
+\def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
+\def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
+
+\def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
+
+\def\placesaveins#1{%
+ \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
+ {\box#1}%
+}
+
+% eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
+{
+ \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
+ \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
+}
+
+% initialization:
+\def\newsaveins #1{%
+ \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
+ \next
+}
+\def\newsaveinsX #1{%
+ \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
+ \checksaveins #1}%
+}
+
+% initialize:
+\let\checkinserts\empty
+\newsaveins\footins
+\newsaveins\margin
+
+
+% @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
+% If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
+%
+% Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
+% time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
+% undone and the next image would fail.
+\openin 1 = epsf.tex
+\ifeof 1 \else
+ % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
+ % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
+ \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
+ \input epsf.tex
+\fi
+\closein 1
+%
+% We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
+\newif\ifwarnednoepsf
+\newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
+ work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
+ it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
+%
+\def\image#1{%
+ \ifx\epsfbox\undefined
+ \ifwarnednoepsf \else
+ \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
+ \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
+ \global\warnednoepsftrue
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
+ \fi
+}
+%
+% Arguments to @image:
+% #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
+% #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
+% #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
+% #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
+% #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing this stuff.
+\newif\ifimagevmode
+\def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
+ \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
+ \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
+ % If the image is by itself, center it.
+ \ifvmode
+ \imagevmodetrue
+ \nobreak\bigskip
+ % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
+ % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
+ % above and below.
+ \nobreak\vskip\parskip
+ \nobreak
+ \line\bgroup\hss
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Output the image.
+ \ifpdf
+ \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
+ \else
+ % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
+ \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ \ifimagevmode \hss \egroup \bigbreak \fi % space after the image
+\endgroup}
+
+
+% @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
+% etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
+% float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
+%
+\envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
+
+% There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
+\def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
+
+% #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
+% "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
+% this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
+%
+% #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
+% be referable.
+%
+% #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
+% will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
+%
+% We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
+% chapter-level command.
+\let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
+%
+\def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
+ \let\thiscaption=\empty
+ \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
+ %
+ % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
+ %
+ % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
+ % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
+ %
+ \startsavinginserts
+ %
+ % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
+ \par
+ %
+ \vtop\bgroup
+ \def\floattype{#1}%
+ \def\floatlabel{#2}%
+ \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
+ %
+ \ifx\floattype\empty
+ \let\safefloattype=\empty
+ \else
+ {%
+ % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
+ % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
+ \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
+ % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
+ % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
+ %
+ \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
+ \global\advance\floatno by 1
+ %
+ {%
+ % This magic value for \thissection is output by \setref as the
+ % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
+ % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
+ % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
+ % lists of floats.
+ %
+ \edef\thissection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
+ \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
+ \vskip\parskip
+ %
+ % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
+ \restorefirstparagraphindent
+}
+
+% we have these possibilities:
+% @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
+% @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
+% @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
+% @float Foo & no caption: Foo
+% @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
+% @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
+% @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
+% @float & no caption:
+%
+\def\Efloat{%
+ \let\floatident = \empty
+ %
+ % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
+ \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
+ %
+ % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
+ \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
+ \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
+ \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
+ \fi
+ % the number.
+ \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
+ % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
+ \let\captionline = \floatident
+ %
+ \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
+ \ifx\floatident\empty \else
+ \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
+ \fi
+ %
+ % caption text.
+ \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
+ % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
+ \ifx\captionline\empty \else
+ \vskip.5\parskip
+ \captionline
+ %
+ % Space below caption.
+ \vskip\parskip
+ \fi
+ %
+ % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
+ % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
+ \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
+ % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
+ % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
+ % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
+ {%
+ \atdummies
+ % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
+ % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
+ % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
+ \scanexp{%
+ \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
+ \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
+ \thiscaption
+ \else
+ \thisshortcaption
+ \fi
+ }%
+ }%
+ \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
+ \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
+ }%
+ \fi
+ \egroup % end of \vtop
+ %
+ % place the captured inserts
+ %
+ % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
+ % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
+ %
+ \checkinserts
+}
+
+% Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
+%
+\def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
+ \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
+}
+
+% @caption, @shortcaption
+%
+\def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
+\def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
+\def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
+\def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
+
+% The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
+% going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
+\def\getfloatno#1{%
+ \ifx#1\relax
+ % Haven't seen this figure type before.
+ \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
+ %
+ % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
+ \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
+ \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
+ \fi
+ \let\floatno#1%
+}
+
+% \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
+% to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
+% first read the @float command.
+%
+\def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
+
+% Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
+% distinguish floats from other xref types.
+\def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
+
+% #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
+% which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
+% \thissection value which we \setref above.
+%
+\def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
+%
+% #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
+% (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
+%
+\def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
+ \def\temp{#1}%
+ \def\iffloattype{#2}%
+ \ifx\temp\floatmagic
+}
+
+% @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
+%
+\parseargdef\listoffloats{%
+ \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
+ {%
+ % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
+ % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
+ \indexnofonts
+ \turnoffactive
+ \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
+ }%
+ %
+ % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
+ \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
+ \ifhavexrefs
+ % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
+ \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
+ \fi
+ \else
+ \begingroup
+ \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
+ \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
+ \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
+ \endgroup
+ \fi
+}
+
+% This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
+% xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
+% aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
+% has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
+%
+% Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
+% they won't appear in the aux file).
+%
+\def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
+\def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
+ % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
+ % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
+ % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
+ % in pdf output.
+ \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
+ %
+ % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
+ \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
+ \writeentry
+}}
+
+\message{localization,}
+% and i18n.
+
+% @documentlanguage is usually given very early, just after
+% @setfilename. If done too late, it may not override everything
+% properly. Single argument is the language abbreviation.
+% It would be nice if we could set up a hyphenation file here.
+%
+\parseargdef\documentlanguage{%
+ \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
+ % Read the file if it exists.
+ \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
+ \ifeof 1
+ \errhelp = \nolanghelp
+ \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
+ \else
+ \input txi-#1.tex
+ \fi
+ \closein 1
+ \endgroup
+}
+\newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
+is empty. Maybe you need to install it? In the current directory
+should work if nowhere else does.}
+
+
+% @documentencoding should change something in TeX eventually, most
+% likely, but for now just recognize it.
+\let\documentencoding = \comment
+
+
+% Page size parameters.
+%
+\newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
+
+\chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
+\secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
+\subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
+
+% Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
+\vbadness = 10000
+
+% Don't be so finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
+\hbadness = 2000
+
+% Following George Bush, just get rid of widows and orphans.
+\widowpenalty=10000
+\clubpenalty=10000
+
+% Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
+% using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
+% stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
+% \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
+%
+\def\setemergencystretch{%
+ \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
+ % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
+ \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
+ \else
+ \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
+ \fi
+}
+
+% Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
+% 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
+% 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
+%
+% We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
+% \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
+%
+\def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
+ \voffset = #3\relax
+ \topskip = #6\relax
+ \splittopskip = \topskip
+ %
+ \vsize = #1\relax
+ \advance\vsize by \topskip
+ \outervsize = \vsize
+ \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
+ \pageheight = \vsize
+ %
+ \hsize = #2\relax
+ \outerhsize = \hsize
+ \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
+ \pagewidth = \hsize
+ %
+ \normaloffset = #4\relax
+ \bindingoffset = #5\relax
+ %
+ \ifpdf
+ \pdfpageheight #7\relax
+ \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
+ \fi
+ %
+ \setleading{\textleading}
+ %
+ \parindent = \defaultparindent
+ \setemergencystretch
+}
+
+% @letterpaper (the default).
+\def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
+ \textleading = 13.2pt
+ %
+ % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
+ \internalpagesizes{46\baselineskip}{6in}%
+ {\voffset}{.25in}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
+ {11in}{8.5in}%
+}}
+
+% Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
+\def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
+ \textleading = 12pt
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
+ {\voffset}{.25in}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
+ {9.25in}{7in}%
+ %
+ \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
+ \tolerance = 700
+ \hfuzz = 1pt
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = .5cm
+}}
+
+% Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
+% (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
+\def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
+ \textleading = 12pt
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
+ {-.2in}{-.4in}%
+ {0pt}{14pt}%
+ {9in}{6in}%
+ %
+ \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
+ \tolerance = 700
+ \hfuzz = 1pt
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = .4cm
+}}
+
+% Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
+\def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
+ \textleading = 13.2pt
+ %
+ % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
+ % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
+ % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
+ % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
+ % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
+ % your texinfo source file like this:
+ % @tex
+ % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
+ % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
+ % @end tex
+ \internalpagesizes{51\baselineskip}{160mm}
+ {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
+ {297mm}{210mm}%
+ %
+ \tolerance = 700
+ \hfuzz = 1pt
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = 5mm
+}}
+
+% Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
+% From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
+% He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
+\def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
+ \textleading = 12.5pt
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
+ {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
+ {210mm}{148mm}%
+ %
+ \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
+ \tolerance = 800
+ \hfuzz = 1.2pt
+ \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
+ \defbodyindent = 2mm
+ \tableindent = 12mm
+}}
+
+% A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
+\def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \afourpaper
+ \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
+ {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
+ {297mm}{210mm}%
+ %
+ % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
+ \globaldefs = 0
+}}
+
+% Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
+\def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
+ \afourpaper
+ \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
+ {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
+ {297mm}{210mm}%
+ \globaldefs = 0
+}}
+
+% @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
+% Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
+% and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
+%
+\parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
+\def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
+ \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
+ \globaldefs = 1
+ %
+ \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
+ \setleading{\textleading}%
+ %
+ \dimen0 = #1
+ \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
+ %
+ \dimen2 = \hsize
+ \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
+ %
+ \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
+ {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
+ {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
+ {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
+}}
+
+% Set default to letter.
+%
+\letterpaper
+
+
+\message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
+
+% Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
+\catcode`\"=\other
+\catcode`\~=\other
+\catcode`\^=\other
+\catcode`\_=\other
+\catcode`\|=\other
+\catcode`\<=\other
+\catcode`\>=\other
+\catcode`\+=\other
+\catcode`\$=\other
+\def\normaldoublequote{"}
+\def\normaltilde{~}
+\def\normalcaret{^}
+\def\normalunderscore{_}
+\def\normalverticalbar{|}
+\def\normalless{<}
+\def\normalgreater{>}
+\def\normalplus{+}
+\def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
+
+% This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
+% (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
+% where something hairier probably needs to be done.
+%
+% #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
+% otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
+% interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
+% typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
+%
+\def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
+
+% Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
+% non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
+% italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
+% this is not a problem.
+\def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
+
+% Turn off all special characters except @
+% (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
+% Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
+% use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
+
+\catcode`\"=\active
+\def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
+\let"=\activedoublequote
+\catcode`\~=\active
+\def~{{\tt\char126}}
+\chardef\hat=`\^
+\catcode`\^=\active
+\def^{{\tt \hat}}
+
+\catcode`\_=\active
+\def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
+\let\realunder=_
+% Subroutine for the previous macro.
+\def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
+
+\catcode`\|=\active
+\def|{{\tt\char124}}
+\chardef \less=`\<
+\catcode`\<=\active
+\def<{{\tt \less}}
+\chardef \gtr=`\>
+\catcode`\>=\active
+\def>{{\tt \gtr}}
+\catcode`\+=\active
+\def+{{\tt \char 43}}
+\catcode`\$=\active
+\def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
+
+% If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
+% name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
+% So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
+% \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
+\def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
+
+\catcode`\@=0
+
+% \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
+% as in \char`\\.
+\global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
+\global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
+
+% \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
+% \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
+% catcode other.
+{\catcode`\\=\active
+ @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
+ @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
+}
+
+% \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
+% \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
+{\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
+
+% \normalbackslash outputs one backslash in fixed width font.
+\def\normalbackslash{{\tt\backslashcurfont}}
+
+\catcode`\\=\active
+
+% Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters
+% even after parsing them.
+@def@turnoffactive{%
+ @let"=@normaldoublequote
+ @let\=@realbackslash
+ @let~=@normaltilde
+ @let^=@normalcaret
+ @let_=@normalunderscore
+ @let|=@normalverticalbar
+ @let<=@normalless
+ @let>=@normalgreater
+ @let+=@normalplus
+ @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
+ @unsepspaces
+}
+
+% Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
+% the literal character `\'. (Thus, \ is not expandable when this is in
+% effect.)
+%
+@def@normalturnoffactive{@turnoffactive @let\=@normalbackslash}
+
+% Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
+% This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
+@otherifyactive
+
+% If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
+% That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
+% a backslash.
+%
+@gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
+@global@let\ = @eatinput
+
+% On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
+% the first `\{ in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
+% that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
+% Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
+% file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
+%
+@gdef@fixbackslash{%
+ @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
+ @catcode`+=@active
+ @catcode`@_=@active
+}
+
+% Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
+@escapechar = `@@
+
+% These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
+@catcode`@& = @other
+@catcode`@# = @other
+@catcode`@% = @other
+
+
+@c Local variables:
+@c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
+@c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
+@c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
+@c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
+@c time-stamp-end: "}"
+@c End:
+
+@c vim:sw=2:
+
+@ignore
+ arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
+@end ignore